1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3@c This is part of the GCC manual.
4@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6@node Target Macros
7@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8@cindex machine description macros
9@cindex target description macros
10@cindex macros, target description
11@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18@file{.md} file.  The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19@file{@var{machine}.h}.  The header file @file{config.h} includes
20@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}.  The
21source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23machine.  @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27@menu
28* Target Structure::    The @code{targetm} variable.
29* Driver::              Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30* Run-time Target::     Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31* Per-Function Data::   Defining data structures for per-function information.
32* Storage Layout::      Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33* Type Layout::         Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34* Registers::           Naming and describing the hardware registers.
35* Register Classes::    Defining the classes of hardware registers.
36* Old Constraints::     The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
37* Stack and Calling::   Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38* Varargs::		Defining the varargs macros.
39* Trampolines::         Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40* Library Calls::       Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41* Addressing Modes::    Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42* Anchored Addresses::  Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
43* Condition Code::      Defining how insns update the condition code.
44* Costs::               Defining relative costs of different operations.
45* Scheduling::          Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
46* Sections::            Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
47* PIC::			Macros for position independent code.
48* Assembler Format::    Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
49* Debugging Info::      Defining the format of debugging output.
50* Floating Point::      Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
51* Mode Switching::      Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
52* Target Attributes::   Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
53* MIPS Coprocessors::   MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
54* PCH Target::          Validity checking for precompiled headers.
55* C++ ABI::             Controlling C++ ABI changes.
56* Misc::                Everything else.
57@end menu
58
59@node Target Structure
60@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61@cindex target hooks
62@cindex target functions
63
64@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67machine.  The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70for elements of the structure.  The @file{.c} file should override those
71macros for which the default definition is inappropriate.  For example:
72@smallexample
73#include "target.h"
74#include "target-def.h"
75
76/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.}  */
77
78#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82@end smallexample
83@end deftypevar
84
85Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87``Target Hook'' with a prototype.  Many macros will change in future
88from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89@code{targetm} structure.
90
91@node Driver
92@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
93@cindex driver
94@cindex controlling the compilation driver
95
96@c prevent bad page break with this line
97You can control the compilation driver.
98
99@defmac SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
100A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
101takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
102option takes--zero, for many options.
103
104By default, this macro is defined as
105@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
106properly.  You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
107wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
108should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
109additional options.
110@end defmac
111
112@defmac WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
113A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
114takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
115option takes--zero, for many options.  This macro rather than
116@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
117
118By default, this macro is defined as
119@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
120properly.  You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
121wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
122should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
123additional options.
124@end defmac
125
126@defmac SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
127A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
128stops compilation before the generation of an executable.  The value is
129boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
130generated, zero otherwise.
131
132By default, this macro is defined as
133@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
134options properly.  You need not define
135@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
136options which affect the generation of an executable.  Any redefinition
137should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
138for additional options.
139@end defmac
140
141@defmac SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
142A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
143the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
144
145If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
146@end defmac
147
148@defmac TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
149If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
150potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
151second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
152supported) list of options with which to replace the first option.  The
153target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
154are valid.  Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
155must be the @code{-opt} style.  It is the intention of this macro to
156provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
157such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
158multilibs.  Example nonsensical definition, where @option{-malt-abi},
159@option{-EB}, and @option{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
160
161@smallexample
162#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
163@{ "-fast",   "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
164@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
165@end smallexample
166@end defmac
167
168@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
169A list of specs for the driver itself.  It should be a suitable
170initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
171
172The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
173default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
174choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands.  It
175applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
176options added by earlier ones.  It is also possible to remove options
177using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
178
179This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
180options.  It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
181that the other specs are easier to write.
182
183Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184@end defmac
185
186@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
187A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
188@option{--with} options) in the driver.  It should be a suitable initializer
189for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
190outermost pair of surrounding braces.
191
192The first item in the pair is the name of the default.  This must match
193the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target.  The second item is a spec
194to apply if a default with this name was specified.  The string
195@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
196everywhere it occurs.
197
198The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
199default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
200the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
201
202Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
203@end defmac
204
205@defmac CPP_SPEC
206A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
207pass to CPP@.  It can also specify how to translate options you
208give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
209
210Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
211@end defmac
212
213@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
214This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
215than C@.  If you do not define this macro, then the value of
216@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
217@end defmac
218
219@defmac CC1_SPEC
220A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
221pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
222front ends.
223It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
224for GCC to pass to front ends.
225
226Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
227@end defmac
228
229@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
230A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
231pass to @code{cc1plus}.  It can also specify how to translate options you
232give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
233
234Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
235Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
236@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
237CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac ASM_SPEC
241A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
242pass to the assembler.  It can also specify how to translate options
243you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
244See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
245
246Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
247@end defmac
248
249@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
250A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
251run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
252Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{mips.h} for
253an example of this.
254
255Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
256@end defmac
257
258@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
259Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
260an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
261read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
262output of the compiler proper).  This argument is given after any
263@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
264
265If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
266standard input if given no non-option arguments.  If your assembler
267cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
268see @file{mips.h} for instance.
269@end defmac
270
271@defmac LINK_SPEC
272A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
273pass to the linker.  It can also specify how to translate options you
274give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
275
276Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
277@end defmac
278
279@defmac LIB_SPEC
280Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The difference
281between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
282command given to the linker.
283
284If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
285loads the standard C library from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
286@end defmac
287
288@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
289Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
290how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
291linker command line.  This constant is placed both before and after
292the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
293
294If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
295passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
296@end defmac
297
298@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
299By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
300@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
301instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
302depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
303@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}.  On
304targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
305@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead.  @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
306driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
307line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
311A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
312mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.  If nonzero, a spec will be
313generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
314static exception handler library, when linking without any of
315@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
316@end defmac
317
318@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
319If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
320When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
321the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
322@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
323@end defmac
324
325@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
326Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
327difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
328the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
329
330If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
331standard C startup file from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
332@end defmac
333
334@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
335Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
336difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
337the very end of the command given to the linker.
338
339Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
340@end defmac
341
342@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
343GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
344However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
345models, such as AIX 4.3.  On such platforms, define
346@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
347blanks that names one of the recognized thread models.  @code{%*}, the
348default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
349@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
350@end defmac
351
352@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
353Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
354configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
355et al, within sysroot+suffix.
356@end defmac
357
358@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
359Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
360GCC is configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to pass the
361updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
362usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
363@end defmac
364
365@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
366Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
367@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
368@code{CC1_SPEC}.
369
370The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
371containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
372string constant that provides the specification.
373
374Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
375
376@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
377related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
378to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
379these definitions.
380
381For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
382define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
383used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
384used.
385
386The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
387
388@smallexample
389#define EXTRA_SPECS \
390  @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
391
392#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
393@end smallexample
394
395The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
396@smallexample
397#undef CPP_SPEC
398#define CPP_SPEC \
399"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
400%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
401%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
402%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
403
404#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
405#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
406@end smallexample
407
408while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
409@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
410
411@smallexample
412#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
413#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
414@end smallexample
415@end defmac
416
417@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
418Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
419@file{libgcc.a}.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
420the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
421@end defmac
422
423@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
424The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
425By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
426@end defmac
427
428@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
429A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
430linker.  When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
431change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}.  Therefore,
432define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
433line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
434the effect you need.  Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
435@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
436@end defmac
437
438@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
439A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
440directories from linking commands.  Do not give it a nonzero value if
441removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
442@end defmac
443
444@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
445Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
446string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
447target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
448@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
449
450Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
451the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
452@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
453@xref{Target Fragment}.
454@end defmac
455
456@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
457Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
458a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
459indicates an absolute file name.
460@end defmac
461
462@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
463If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
464@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
465when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
466compiler.  If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
467to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
468@end defmac
469
470@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
471Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
472standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
473try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
474@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
475is built as a cross compiler.
476@end defmac
477
478@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
479Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
480standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
481when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
482@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
483is built as a cross compiler.
484@end defmac
485
486@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
487Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
488standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
489default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
490@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
491is built as a cross compiler.
492@end defmac
493
494@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
495If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
496standard prefixes.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
497@option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
498compiler.
499@end defmac
500
501@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
502If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
503standard prefixes.  It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
504used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
505@end defmac
506
507@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
508Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
509variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
510loader.  The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
511initialize the necessary environment variables.
512@end defmac
513
514@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
515Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
516standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
517try when searching for local header files.  @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
518comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
519
520Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
521replacement.
522@end defmac
523
524@defmac MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
525Define this macro if you wish to define command-line switches that
526modify the default target name.
527
528For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
529part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
530configuration name, if present.  The definition should be an initializer
531for an array of structures.  Each array element should have three
532elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
533dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
534indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
535to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
536
537For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
538configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
539and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
540code
541
542@smallexample
543#define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
544  @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
545     @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
546@end smallexample
547@end defmac
548
549@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
550Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
551system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
552directory.  @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
553@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
554
555Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
556specified.
557@end defmac
558
559@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
560Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
561standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
562try when searching for header files.
563
564Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
565@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
566@end defmac
567
568@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
569The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
570See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
571If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
572@end defmac
573
574@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
575Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
576for include files.  For a native compiler, the default search path
577usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
578@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
579@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.  In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
580and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
581and specify private search areas for GCC@.  The directory
582@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
583
584The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
585Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
586string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
587for C++-only directories,
588and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
589wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++.  Mark the end of
590the array with a null element.
591
592The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
593if any, in all uppercase letters.  For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
594or @samp{BINUTILS}.  If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
595operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
596
597For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
598
599@smallexample
600#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
601@{                                       \
602  @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@},   \
603  @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@},    \
604  @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@},  \
605  @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@},                      \
606  @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@}                         \
607@}
608@end smallexample
609@end defmac
610
611Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
612
613@enumerate
614@item
615Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
616
617@item
618The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
619
620@item
621The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
622
623@item
624The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
625
626@item
627@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
628
629@item
630The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
631@end enumerate
632
633Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
634
635@enumerate
636@item
637Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
638
639@item
640The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
641
642@item
643The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
644(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
645
646@item
647The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
648
649@item
650@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
651
652@item
653The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
654
655@item
656The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
657
658@item
659The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
660
661@item
662@file{/lib/}.
663
664@item
665@file{/usr/lib/}.
666@end enumerate
667
668@node Run-time Target
669@section Run-time Target Specification
670@cindex run-time target specification
671@cindex predefined macros
672@cindex target specifications
673
674@c prevent bad page break with this line
675Here are run-time target specifications.
676
677@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
678This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
679built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target cpu, using
680the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
681@code{builtin_assert}.  When the front end
682calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
683finished command line option processing your code can use those
684results freely.
685
686@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
687command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
688the assertion.  @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
689accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
690
691@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
692object-like macro.  If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
693@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally.  Otherwise, it
694defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
695with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
696only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line.  For
697example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
698and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
699@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
700defines only @code{_ABI64}.
701
702You can also test for the C dialect being compiled.  The variable
703@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c} or
704@code{clk_cplusplus}.  Note that if we are preprocessing assembler,
705this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like macro
706@code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want to
707check for that first.  If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
708variable @code{flag_iso} can be used.  The function-like macro
709@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
710preprocessing.
711@end defmac
712
713@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
714Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
715and is used for the target operating system instead.
716@end defmac
717
718@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
719Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
720and is used for the target object format.  @file{elfos.h} uses this
721macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
722it yourself.
723@end defmac
724
725@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
726This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
727any target-specific headers.
728@end deftypevar
729
730@deftypevar {Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
731This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
732Its default setting is 0.
733@end deftypevar
734
735@cindex optional hardware or system features
736@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
737
738@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
739This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
740target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
741(@pxref{Options}).  It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
742processing and should return true if the option is valid.  The default
743definition does nothing but return true.
744
745@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
746associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
747the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
748underscores.  @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
749no argument was given.  If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
750(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
751argument.  Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
752option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
753@end deftypefn
754
755@defmac TARGET_VERSION
756This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
757describing the particular machine description choice.  Every machine
758description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}.  For example:
759
760@smallexample
761#ifdef MOTOROLA
762#define TARGET_VERSION \
763  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
764#else
765#define TARGET_VERSION \
766  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
767#endif
768@end smallexample
769@end defmac
770
771@defmac OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
772Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
773a particular target machine.  You can define a macro
774@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this.  This macro, if
775defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
776parsed.
777
778Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
779@option{-O}.  That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
780@end defmac
781
782@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
783This is similar to @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} but is only used in the C
784language frontends (C, C++) and so can be used to alter option flag
785variables which only exist in those frontends.
786@end defmac
787
788@defmac OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
789Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
790various optimization levels.   This macro, if defined, is executed once
791just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
792of the command options have been parsed.  Values set in this macro are
793used as the default values for the other command line options.
794
795@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
796specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
797
798@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
799
800You should not use this macro to change options that are not
801machine-specific.  These should uniformly selected by the same
802optimization level on all supported machines.  Use this macro to enable
803machine-specific optimizations.
804
805@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
806this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
807generated code.
808@end defmac
809
810@defmac CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
811Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
812pointer.  If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
813@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
814@end defmac
815
816@node Per-Function Data
817@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
818@cindex per-function data
819@cindex data structures
820
821If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
822provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this.  Note, just
823using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
824nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
825when another one comes along.
826
827GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
828contains all of the data specific to an individual function.  This
829structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
830@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
831to their own specific data.
832
833If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
834@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
835This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
836@code{init_machine_status}.  This pointer is explained below.
837
838One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
839RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address.  This
840RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
841function, for level 0.
842
843Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
844all of the per-function information.  Thus when processing of a nested
845function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
846stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
847stack.  GCC used to provide function pointers called
848@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
849the saving and restoring of the target specific information.  Since the
850single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
851longer supported.
852
853@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
854Macro called to initialize any target specific information.  This macro
855is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
856The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
857function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
858@end defmac
859
860@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
861If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
862function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
863target to perform any target specific initialization of the
864@code{struct function} structure.  It is intended that this would be
865used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
866
867@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
868Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
869@code{ggc_alloc}, including the structure itself.
870@end deftypevar
871
872@node Storage Layout
873@section Storage Layout
874@cindex storage layout
875
876Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
877alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant.  They can be C
878expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
879@xref{Run-time Target}.
880
881@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
882Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
883byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
884This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
885bit.  If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
886be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to.  This
887macro need not be a constant.
888
889This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
890bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
891@end defmac
892
893@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
894Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
895word has the lowest number.  This macro need not be a constant.
896@end defmac
897
898@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
899Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
900most significant word has the lowest number.  This applies to both
901memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
902order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers.  This
903macro need not be a constant.
904@end defmac
905
906@defmac LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
907Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant.  This must be a
908constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
909used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}.  Typically the value will be set
910based on preprocessor defines.
911@end defmac
912
913@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
914Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
915@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
916containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
917have the value 0.  This macro need not be a constant.
918
919You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
920multi-word integers.
921@end defmac
922
923@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
924Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
925unit (byte).  If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
926@end defmac
927
928@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
929Number of bits in a word.  If you do not define this macro, the default
930is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
931@end defmac
932
933@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
934Maximum number of bits in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
935@code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
936largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
937@end defmac
938
939@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
940Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
941register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
942@end defmac
943
944@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
945Minimum number of units in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
946@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
947smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
948@end defmac
949
950@defmac UNITS_PER_SIMD_WORD
951Number of units in the vectors that the vectorizer can produce.
952The default is equal to @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}, because the vectorizer
953can do some transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD}
954hardware.
955@end defmac
956
957@defmac POINTER_SIZE
958Width of a pointer, in bits.  You must specify a value no wider than the
959width of @code{Pmode}.  If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
960you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.  If you do not specify
961a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
962@end defmac
963
964@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
965A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
966extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
967be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended.  If the value
968is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
969extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
970
971You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
972to the width of @code{Pmode}.
973@end defmac
974
975@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
976A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
977is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
978stored in a register.  This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
979scalar type.
980
981On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
982register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
983@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  In most
984cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
985floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
986counterparts.
987
988For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
989However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
990either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes.  For example, on
991the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
992sign-extend the result to 64 bits.  On such machines, set
993@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
994
995Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
996@end defmac
997
998@defmac PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
999Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but is applied to outgoing function arguments or
1000function return values, as specified by @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1001and @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1002
1003The default is @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1004@end defmac
1005
1006@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS (tree @var{fntype})
1007This target hook should return @code{true} if the promotion described by
1008@code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE} should be done for outgoing function
1009arguments.
1010@end deftypefn
1011
1012@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN (tree @var{fntype})
1013This target hook should return @code{true} if the promotion described by
1014@code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE} should be done for the return value of
1015functions.
1016
1017If this target hook returns @code{true}, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}
1018must perform the same promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE}.
1019@end deftypefn
1020
1021@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
1022Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1023bits.  All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1024regardless of data type.  On most machines, this is the same as the
1025size of an integer.
1026@end defmac
1027
1028@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
1029Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1030stack pointer on this machine.  The definition is a C expression for the
1031desired alignment (measured in bits).  This value is used as a default
1032if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.  On most machines,
1033this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1034@end defmac
1035
1036@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1037Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1038stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces.  The definition
1039is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits).  This
1040macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1041@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1042@end defmac
1043
1044@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1045Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1046@end defmac
1047
1048@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1049Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1050@end defmac
1051
1052@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1053If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1054object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1055nearby object.  Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1056on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1057@end defmac
1058
1059@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1060Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1061machine, in bits.  If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1062structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1063by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1064@end defmac
1065
1066@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1067An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1068alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1069@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1070alignment) is @var{computed}.  It overrides alignment only if the
1071field alignment has not been set by the
1072@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1073@end defmac
1074
1075@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1076Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1077Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1078@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  If not defined,
1079the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1080@end defmac
1081
1082@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1083If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1084the static store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1085the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1086macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1087
1088If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1089
1090@findex strcpy
1091One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1092make it all fit in fewer cache lines.  Another is to cause character
1093arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1094constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1095@end defmac
1096
1097@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1098If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1099that is being placed in memory.  @var{constant} is the constant and
1100@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1101have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1102align the object.
1103
1104If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1105
1106The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1107constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1108constants can be done inline.
1109@end defmac
1110
1111@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1112If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1113the local store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1114the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1115macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1116
1117If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1118
1119One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1120make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1121@end defmac
1122
1123@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1124Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1125empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1126
1127If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1128@end defmac
1129
1130@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1131Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1132Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1133
1134If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1135@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1136@end defmac
1137
1138@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1139Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1140if given data not on the nominal alignment.  If instructions will merely
1141go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1142@end defmac
1143
1144@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1145Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1146alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1147
1148The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1149@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1150structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1151that type.  In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1152that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1153
1154Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1155@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1156four-byte alignment for the whole structure.  (The alignment used may
1157not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1158
1159An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1160structure.
1161
1162If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1163a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1164
1165Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1166bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary.  The compiler can
1167support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1168@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1169
1170The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1171@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1172Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1173
1174Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1175@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1176@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1177
1178If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1179bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1180what the other compiler does.  Compile and run this program:
1181
1182@smallexample
1183struct foo1
1184@{
1185  char x;
1186  char :0;
1187  char y;
1188@};
1189
1190struct foo2
1191@{
1192  char x;
1193  int :0;
1194  char y;
1195@};
1196
1197main ()
1198@{
1199  printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1200          sizeof (struct foo1));
1201  printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1202          sizeof (struct foo2));
1203  exit (0);
1204@}
1205@end smallexample
1206
1207If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1208get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1209@end defmac
1210
1211@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1212Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1213to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1214@end defmac
1215
1216@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELDS (void)
1217When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1218whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1219structure.  The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1220the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1221@end deftypefn
1222
1223@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELDS (void)
1224This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1225should use the narrowest mode possible.  It should return @code{false} if
1226these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1227
1228The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1229@end deftypefn
1230
1231@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1232Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1233@code{BLKMODE}.
1234
1235If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1236mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode.  @var{mode} is provided in the
1237case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1238retain the field's mode.
1239
1240Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1241of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1242field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1243@end defmac
1244
1245@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1246Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1247by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1248way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1249@var{specified}.
1250
1251The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1252the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1253@end defmac
1254
1255@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1256An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1257machine mode that should actually be used.  All integer machine modes of
1258this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1259appropriate sizes.  If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1260(DImode)} is assumed.
1261@end defmac
1262
1263@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1264If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1265specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1266@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1267@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1268@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1269having its mode specified.
1270
1271You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}.  You
1272would most commonly define this macro if the
1273@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
127464-bit mode.
1275@end defmac
1276
1277@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1278If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1279specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1280@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1281
1282You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1283You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1284pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1285@end defmac
1286
1287@defmac TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1288A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1289There are four defined values:
1290
1291@ftable @code
1292@item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1293This code indicates IEEE floating point.  It is the default; there is no
1294need to define @code{TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT} when the format is IEEE@.
1295
1296@item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1297This code indicates the ``F float'' (for @code{float}) and ``D float''
1298or ``G float'' formats (for @code{double}) used on the VAX and PDP-11@.
1299
1300@item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1301This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
1302
1303@item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1304This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
1305@end ftable
1306
1307If your target uses a floating point format other than these, you must
1308define a new @var{name}_FLOAT_FORMAT code for it, and add support for
1309it to @file{real.c}.
1310
1311The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1312memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
1313@end defmac
1314
1315@defmac MODE_HAS_NANS (@var{mode})
1316When defined, this macro should be true if @var{mode} has a NaN
1317representation.  The compiler assumes that NaNs are not equal to
1318anything (including themselves) and that addition, subtraction,
1319multiplication and division all return NaNs when one operand is
1320NaN@.
1321
1322By default, this macro is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1323mode and the target floating-point format is IEEE@.
1324@end defmac
1325
1326@defmac MODE_HAS_INFINITIES (@var{mode})
1327This macro should be true if @var{mode} can represent infinity.  At
1328present, the compiler uses this macro to decide whether @samp{x - x}
1329is always defined.  By default, the macro is true when @var{mode}
1330is a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1331@end defmac
1332
1333@defmac MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS (@var{mode})
1334True if @var{mode} distinguishes between positive and negative zero.
1335The rules are expected to follow the IEEE standard:
1336
1337@itemize @bullet
1338@item
1339@samp{x + x} has the same sign as @samp{x}.
1340
1341@item
1342If the sum of two values with opposite sign is zero, the result is
1343positive for all rounding modes expect towards @minus{}infinity, for
1344which it is negative.
1345
1346@item
1347The sign of a product or quotient is negative when exactly one
1348of the operands is negative.
1349@end itemize
1350
1351The default definition is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1352mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1353@end defmac
1354
1355@defmac MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING (@var{mode})
1356If defined, this macro should be true for @var{mode} if it has at
1357least one rounding mode in which @samp{x} and @samp{-x} can be
1358rounded to numbers of different magnitude.  Two such modes are
1359towards @minus{}infinity and towards +infinity.
1360
1361The default definition of this macro is true if @var{mode} is
1362a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1363@end defmac
1364
1365@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1366If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1367mode is towards zero.  A true value has the following effects:
1368
1369@itemize @bullet
1370@item
1371@code{MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING} will be false for all modes.
1372
1373@item
1374@file{libgcc.a}'s floating-point emulator will round towards zero
1375rather than towards nearest.
1376
1377@item
1378The compiler's floating-point emulator will round towards zero after
1379doing arithmetic, and when converting from the internal float format to
1380the target format.
1381@end itemize
1382
1383The macro does not affect the parsing of string literals.  When the
1384primary rounding mode is towards zero, library functions like
1385@code{strtod} might still round towards nearest, and the compiler's
1386parser should behave like the target's @code{strtod} where possible.
1387
1388Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1389@end defmac
1390
1391@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1392This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1393bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1394exponent for normal numbers instead.
1395
1396Defining this macro to true for @var{size} causes @code{MODE_HAS_NANS}
1397and @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES} to be false for @var{size}-bit modes.
1398It also affects the way @file{libgcc.a} and @file{real.c} emulate
1399floating-point arithmetic.
1400
1401The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1402@end defmac
1403
1404@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_OPAQUE_P (tree @var{type})
1405This target hook should return @code{true} a vector is opaque.  That
1406is, if no cast is needed when copying a vector value of type
1407@var{type} into another vector lvalue of the same size.  Vector opaque
1408types cannot be initialized.  The default is that there are no such
1409types.
1410@end deftypefn
1411
1412@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (tree @var{record_type})
1413This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1414@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1415Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1416unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1417different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1418alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1419bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1420the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1421(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1422another bit-field of nonzero size.  If this hook returns @code{true},
1423other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1424
1425When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1426of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1427bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1428and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1429chunk of 32 bits.  However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1430size is allocated).  In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1431alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1432
1433If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1434the latter will take precedence.  If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1435used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1436precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1437may affect its placement.
1438@end deftypefn
1439
1440@deftypefn {Target Hook} {bool} TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1441Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1442@end deftypefn
1443
1444@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_FUNDAMENTAL_TYPE (tree @var{type})
1445If your target defines any fundamental types, define this hook to
1446return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1447mangled name.  The @var{type} argument is the tree structure
1448representing the type to be mangled.  The hook may be applied to trees
1449which are not target-specific fundamental types; it should return
1450@code{NULL} for all such types, as well as arguments it does not
1451recognize.  If the return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to
1452a statically-allocated string constant.
1453
1454Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1455qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types.  Encode new
1456fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1457is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1458length of @var{name} in decimal.  Encode qualified versions of
1459ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1460@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1461@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1462code used to represent the unqualified version of this type.  (See
1463@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1464codes.)  In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1465spaces in your string.
1466
1467The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1468appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1469types.
1470@end deftypefn
1471
1472@node Type Layout
1473@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1474
1475These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1476basic data types used in programs being compiled.  Unlike the macros in
1477the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1478languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1479
1480@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1481A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1482target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1483@end defmac
1484
1485@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1486A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1487target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1488(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1489unit.)
1490@end defmac
1491
1492@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1493A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1494target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1495@end defmac
1496
1497@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1498On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1499@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@.  In
1500that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1501the size of that type.  If you don't define this, the default is the
1502value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1503@end defmac
1504
1505@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1506A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1507target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1508words.  If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1509macro must be at least 64.
1510@end defmac
1511
1512@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1513A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1514target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1515@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1516@end defmac
1517
1518@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1519A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1520C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine.  If you don't define
1521this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1522@end defmac
1523
1524@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1525A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1526target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1527@end defmac
1528
1529@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1530A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1531target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1532words.
1533@end defmac
1534
1535@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1536A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1537the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1538words.
1539@end defmac
1540
1541@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1542Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1543if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1544@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.  If you don't define this, the
1545default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1546@end defmac
1547
1548@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1549Define this macro if neither @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1550@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1551@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1552anyway.  If you don't define this and either @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1553or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1554otherwise it is 0.
1555@end defmac
1556
1557@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1558Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1559@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1560anyway.  If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1561is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1562@end defmac
1563
1564@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1565Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1566@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1567anyway.  If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1568is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1569@end defmac
1570
1571@defmac SF_SIZE
1572@defmacx DF_SIZE
1573@defmacx XF_SIZE
1574@defmacx TF_SIZE
1575Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1576@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1577if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate.  By default,
1578@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1579for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1580@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1581@code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1582@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1583@end defmac
1584
1585@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1586A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1587assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1588default state.  If you do not define this macro the value of
1589@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1590@end defmac
1591
1592@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1593A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1594supported by the hardware.  If you define this macro, you must specify a
1595value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1596If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1597is the default.
1598@end defmac
1599
1600@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1601An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1602@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default.  The user can
1603always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1604and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1605@end defmac
1606
1607@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1608This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1609@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1610of possible values of that type.  It should return false if all
1611@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1612
1613The default is to return false.
1614@end deftypefn
1615
1616@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1617A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1618for size values.  The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1619contents of the string.
1620
1621The string can contain more than one keyword.  If so, separate them with
1622spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1623appropriate, and finally @code{int}.  The string must exactly match one
1624of the data type names defined in the function
1625@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}.  You may not
1626omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1627crash on startup.
1628
1629If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1630int"}.
1631@end defmac
1632
1633@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1634A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1635for the result of subtracting two pointers.  The typedef name
1636@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string.  See
1637@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1638
1639If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1640@end defmac
1641
1642@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1643A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1644for wide characters.  The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1645the contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1646information.
1647
1648If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1649@end defmac
1650
1651@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1652A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1653characters.  This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1654@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1655@end defmac
1656
1657@defmac WINT_TYPE
1658A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1659use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1660@code{getwc}.  The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1661contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1662information.
1663
1664If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1665@end defmac
1666
1667@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1668A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1669can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1670The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1671string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1672
1673If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1674@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1675much precision as @code{long long int}.
1676@end defmac
1677
1678@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1679A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1680can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1681type.  The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1682of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1683
1684If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1685@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1686unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1687int}.
1688@end defmac
1689
1690@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1691The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1692that looks like:
1693
1694@smallexample
1695  struct @{
1696    union @{
1697      void (*fn)();
1698      ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1699    @};
1700    ptrdiff_t delta;
1701  @};
1702@end smallexample
1703
1704@noindent
1705The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1706will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1707Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1708always be zero.  Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1709distinguish which variant of the union is in use.  But, on some
1710platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work.  In
1711that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1712the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1713
1714GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1715this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1716However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1717set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1718bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1719address is in ARM or Thumb mode.  If this is the case of your
1720architecture, you should define this macro to
1721@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1722
1723In general, you should not have to define this macro.  On architectures
1724in which function addresses are always even, according to
1725@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1726@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1727@end defmac
1728
1729@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1730Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables.  This
1731macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1732instead.  Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1733function pointer is actually a small data structure.  Normally the
1734data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1735pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1736
1737If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1738of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1739@end defmac
1740
1741@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1742By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1743is the same as pointer alignment.  The value of this macro specifies
1744the alignment of the vtable entry in bits.  It should be defined only
1745when special alignment is necessary. */
1746@end defmac
1747
1748@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1749There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1750zero.  If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1751specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1752of words in each data entry.
1753@end defmac
1754
1755@node Registers
1756@section Register Usage
1757@cindex register usage
1758
1759This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1760has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1761
1762The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1763done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}.  For information
1764on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1765For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1766For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1767
1768@menu
1769* Register Basics::		Number and kinds of registers.
1770* Allocation Order::		Order in which registers are allocated.
1771* Values in Registers::		What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1772* Leaf Functions::		Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1773* Stack Registers::		Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1774@end menu
1775
1776@node Register Basics
1777@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1778
1779@c prevent bad page break with this line
1780Registers have various characteristics.
1781
1782@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1783Number of hardware registers known to the compiler.  They receive
1784numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1785pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1786@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1787@end defmac
1788
1789@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1790@cindex fixed register
1791An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1792all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1793general allocation.  These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1794pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1795register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1796machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1797and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1798
1799This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1800commas and surrounded by braces.  The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1801register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1802
1803The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1804the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1805by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1806the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1807@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1808@end defmac
1809
1810@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1811@cindex call-used register
1812@cindex call-clobbered register
1813@cindex call-saved register
1814Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1815clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1816registers.  This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1817available for general allocation of values that must live across
1818function calls.
1819
1820If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1821automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1822exit, if the register is used within the function.
1823@end defmac
1824
1825@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1826@cindex call-used register
1827@cindex call-clobbered register
1828@cindex call-saved register
1829Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1830that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1831(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1832This macro is optional.  If not specified, it defaults to the value
1833of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1834@end defmac
1835
1836@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1837@cindex call-used register
1838@cindex call-clobbered register
1839@cindex call-saved register
1840A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1841value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1842call without some part of it being clobbered.  For most machines this
1843macro need not be defined.  It is only required for machines that do not
1844preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1845@end defmac
1846
1847@findex fixed_regs
1848@findex call_used_regs
1849@findex global_regs
1850@findex reg_names
1851@findex reg_class_contents
1852@defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1853Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1854@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1855@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1856any dependence of these register sets on target flags.  The first three
1857of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1858@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1859@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}.  Before the macro is
1860called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1861@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1862from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1863@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1864@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1865@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1866command options have been applied.
1867
1868You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1869
1870@cindex disabling certain registers
1871@cindex controlling register usage
1872If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1873flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1874@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1875registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@.  Also define
1876the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1877to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1878is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1879
1880(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1881of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1882controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1883these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1884@end defmac
1885
1886@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1887Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1888expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1889corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1890function.  Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1891outbound register.
1892@end defmac
1893
1894@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1895Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1896expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1897corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1898function.  Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1899register.
1900@end defmac
1901
1902@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1903Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1904expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1905register window.  Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1906need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1907gotos.
1908@end defmac
1909
1910@defmac PC_REGNUM
1911If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1912register number.  Otherwise, do not define it.
1913@end defmac
1914
1915@node Allocation Order
1916@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1917@cindex order of register allocation
1918@cindex register allocation order
1919
1920@c prevent bad page break with this line
1921Registers are allocated in order.
1922
1923@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1924If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1925numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1926to use them (from most preferred to least).
1927
1928If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1929(all else being equal).
1930
1931One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1932registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1933instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers.  On such
1934machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1935the highest numbered allocable register first.
1936@end defmac
1937
1938@defmac ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1939A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1940hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1941
1942Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1943Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1944register; and so on.
1945
1946The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1947@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1948
1949On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1950@end defmac
1951
1952@node Values in Registers
1953@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
1954
1955This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
1956(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
1957consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
1958
1959@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1960A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
1961at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
1962@var{mode}.
1963
1964On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
1965definition of this macro is
1966
1967@smallexample
1968#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE)            \
1969   ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)  \
1970    / UNITS_PER_WORD)
1971@end smallexample
1972@end defmac
1973
1974@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1975A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
1976in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
1977in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
1978multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
1979this mode by the number of registers returned by
1980@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}).  By default this is zero.
1981
1982For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
1983registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
1984nonzero.
1985
1986This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
1987@code{subreg_regno_offset} and @code{subreg_offset_representable_p}
1988would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
1989represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
1990@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
1991registers and so not be representable.
1992@end defmac
1993
1994@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1995For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
1996@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
1997returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
1998including any padding.  In the example above, the value would be four.
1999@end defmac
2000
2001@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2002Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2003of mode @var{mode} is not the word size.  It is a C expression that
2004should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode.  It is
2005used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results.  This
2006happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2007floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2008@end defmac
2009
2010@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2011A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2012of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2013registers starting with that one).  For a machine where all registers
2014are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2015
2016@smallexample
2017#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2018@end smallexample
2019
2020You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2021because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2022
2023@cindex register pairs
2024On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2025register pairs.  You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2026odd register numbers for such modes.
2027
2028The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2029@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2030register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2031value into the register and back out not alter it.
2032
2033Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2034all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2035@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2036you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this.  This
2037is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2038and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2039to be tieable.
2040
2041Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2042Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2043in floating point registers.  This is not true.  Any registers that
2044can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2045mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2046registers.  Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2047
2048On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2049modes may not go in floating registers.  This is true if the floating
2050registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2051non-floating value there would garble it.  In this case,
2052@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2053floating registers.  But if the floating registers do not automatically
2054normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2055unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2056register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2057
2058The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2059they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2060instructions.  However, this is of no concern to
2061@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.  You handle it by writing the proper
2062constraints for those instructions.
2063
2064On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2065so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2066register if floating point arithmetic is not being done.  As long as the
2067floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2068be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2069@end defmac
2070
2071@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2072A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2073@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2074
2075One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2076another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2077handler.
2078
2079The default is always nonzero.
2080@end defmac
2081
2082@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2083A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2084@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2085
2086If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2087@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2088any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2089should be nonzero.  If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2090this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2091accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2092
2093You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2094possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2095allocation.
2096@end defmac
2097
2098@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2099Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2100registers.  You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2101@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2102@end defmac
2103
2104@node Leaf Functions
2105@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2106
2107@cindex leaf functions
2108@cindex functions, leaf
2109On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2110more efficiently if it does not make its own register window.  Often this
2111means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2112are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2113normally arrive.
2114
2115The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2116other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2117registers for its own variables and temporaries.  We use the term ``leaf
2118function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2119handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2120functions''.
2121
2122GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2123suitable for leaf function treatment.  So it needs to renumber the
2124registers in order to output a leaf function.  The following macros
2125accomplish this.
2126
2127@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2128Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2129contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2130function treatment.
2131
2132If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2133registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2134GCC would ordinarily allocate.  The registers which will actually be
2135used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2136in this vector.
2137
2138Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2139the treatment of leaf functions.
2140@end defmac
2141
2142@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2143A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2144should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2145
2146If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2147function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2148will cause the compiler to abort.
2149
2150Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2151treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2152this.
2153@end defmac
2154
2155@findex current_function_is_leaf
2156@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2157@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2158@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2159specially.  They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2160which is nonzero for leaf functions.  @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2161set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2162compiler passes.  They can also test the C variable
2163@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2164functions which only use leaf registers.
2165@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2166that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2167@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2168@c changed this to fix overfull.  ALSO:  why the "it" at the beginning
2169@c of the next paragraph?!  --mew 2feb93
2170
2171@node Stack Registers
2172@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2173
2174There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2175``registers'' form a stack.  Stack registers are normally written by
2176pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2177stack.
2178
2179Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2180they must be consecutively numbered.  Furthermore, the existing
2181support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2182point coprocessor.  If you have a new architecture that uses
2183stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2184@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2185with it, as well as defining these macros.
2186
2187@defmac STACK_REGS
2188Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2189@end defmac
2190
2191@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2192The number of the first stack-like register.  This one is the top
2193of the stack.
2194@end defmac
2195
2196@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2197The number of the last stack-like register.  This one is the bottom of
2198the stack.
2199@end defmac
2200
2201@node Register Classes
2202@section Register Classes
2203@cindex register class definitions
2204@cindex class definitions, register
2205
2206On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2207For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2208certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions.  These machine
2209restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2210
2211You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2212which of the registers belong to it.  Then you can specify register classes
2213that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2214
2215@findex ALL_REGS
2216@findex NO_REGS
2217In general, each register will belong to several classes.  In fact, one
2218class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers.  Another
2219class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers.  Often the
2220union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2221
2222@findex GENERAL_REGS
2223One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  There is nothing
2224terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2225@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class.  If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2226the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2227to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2228
2229Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2230then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2231
2232The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2233constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2234You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2235them in operand constraints.
2236
2237You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2238instruction allows both classes.  For example, if an instruction allows
2239either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2240certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2241which includes both of them.  Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2242
2243You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2244classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2245contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2246in their union.
2247
2248When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2249certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2250Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2251a register pair to start with an even-numbered register.  The way to
2252specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2253
2254Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2255instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2256each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2257mode to or from memory.  For example, on some machines, the operations for
2258single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers.  When
2259this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2260instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2261single-byte values can be loaded or stored.  This is so that
2262@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2263
2264@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2265An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2266as enumerated values.  @code{NO_REGS} must be first.  @code{ALL_REGS}
2267must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2268@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2269tells how many classes there are.
2270
2271Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2272the class name to type @code{int}.  The number serves as an index
2273in many of the tables described below.
2274@end deftp
2275
2276@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2277The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2278
2279@smallexample
2280#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2281@end smallexample
2282@end defmac
2283
2284@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2285An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2286constants.  These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2287@end defmac
2288
2289@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2290An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2291which are bit masks.  The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2292@var{n}.  The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2293register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2294
2295When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2296Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2297several integers.  Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2298for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2299In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2300registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2301so on.
2302@end defmac
2303
2304@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2305A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2306@var{regno}.  In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2307which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2308register.
2309@end defmac
2310
2311@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2312A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2313base register must belong.  A base register is one used in an address
2314which is the register value plus a displacement.
2315@end defmac
2316
2317@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2318This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2319the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner.  If
2320@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2321@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2322@end defmac
2323
2324@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2325A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2326base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2327register address.  You should define this macro if base plus index
2328addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2329@end defmac
2330
2331@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2332A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2333base register must belong.  @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2334context in which the base register occurs.  @var{outer_code} is the code of
2335the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2336address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2337@code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2338index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2339@end defmac
2340
2341@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2342A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2343index register must belong.  An index register is one used in an
2344address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2345added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2346@end defmac
2347
2348@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2349A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2350suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.  It may be
2351either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2352allocated such a hard register.
2353@end defmac
2354
2355@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2356A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2357that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2358@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2359reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
2360you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2361@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2362that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e. as an @code{address_operand}.
2363
2364@end defmac
2365
2366@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2367A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2368use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2369memory in mode @var{mode}.  It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2370pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register.  You should
2371define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2372than other base register uses.
2373
2374Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2375@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2376@end defmac
2377
2378@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2379A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2380that expression may examine the context in which the register appears in the
2381memory reference.  @var{outer_code} is the code of the immediately enclosing
2382expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the address, @code{ADDRESS} for
2383something that occurs in an @code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the
2384code of the corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2385@code{SCRATCH} otherwise.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2386that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e. as an @code{address_operand}.
2387@end defmac
2388
2389@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2390A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2391suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses.  It may be
2392either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2393allocated such a hard register.
2394
2395The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2396the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
2397two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2398labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2399labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2400may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
2401looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2402only if neither labeling works.
2403@end defmac
2404
2405@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2406A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2407to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2408@var{class}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2409another, smaller class.  On many machines, the following definition is
2410safe:
2411
2412@smallexample
2413#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2414@end smallexample
2415
2416Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2417example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2418for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2419@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2420Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2421
2422One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2423@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2424loaded into some register class.  By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2425force @var{x} into a memory location.  For example, rs6000 can load
2426immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2427instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2428register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2429@var{x} is a floating-point constant.  If the constant can't be loaded
2430into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2431@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2432of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2433
2434If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2435through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2436to find the best one.  Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2437reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2438this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2439the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2440@end defmac
2441
2442@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2443Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2444input reloads.  If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2445@var{class}, unchanged.
2446
2447You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2448reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2449@end defmac
2450
2451@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2452A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2453to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2454@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2455ordinarily be used.
2456
2457Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2458there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2459
2460The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2461smaller class.
2462
2463Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2464require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2465@end defmac
2466
2467@deftypefn {Target Hook} enum reg_class TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, enum reg_class @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2468Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2469from memory or even from other types of registers.  An example is the
2470@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2471from general registers, but not memory.  Below, we shall be using the
2472term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2473directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2474register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2475destination.  An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2476source and destination.  Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2477reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2478and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2479intermediate register still holds the required value.
2480
2481Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2482allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2483register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2484address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2485when compiling PIC)@.  Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2486as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value that
2487that being copied.  Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2488describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2489these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2490of the scratch register(s).
2491
2492In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2493
2494For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2495and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register in of class
2496@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}.  For output reloads, this target
2497hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_mode}
2498needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2499
2500If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2501an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2502return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2503If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2504If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2505that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2506
2507If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2508perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2509closest intermediate register.  Or if no intermediate register is
2510required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2511copy  from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2512
2513You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2514in the md file which performs the move.  Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2515and input of this copy, respectively.  Operands from operand 2 onward are
2516for scratch operands.  These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2517single-register-class
2518@c [later: or memory]
2519output constraint.
2520
2521When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2522hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2523register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2524have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2525
2526@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2527@c   the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2528@c   and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2529@c   alternative.  A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2530@c   against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2531@c   constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2532@c   arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2533@c   Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2534
2535
2536@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2537pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2538Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2539in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2540
2541Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2542currently not supported.  For the time being, you will have to continue
2543to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2544
2545@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2546copied.  If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2547(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2548Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2549of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2550forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2551@end deftypefn
2552
2553@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2554@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2555@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2556These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2557@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2558
2559These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2560target hook.  Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2561reload phase that it may
2562need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2563register to contain the data.  Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2564register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2565you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2566largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2567intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2568
2569If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2570intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2571was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2572class required.  If the
2573requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2574@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2575macros identically.
2576
2577The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2578Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2579can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2580@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register.  Do not define this
2581macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2582
2583If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2584intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2585@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2586(@pxref{Standard Names}.  These patterns, which were normally
2587implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2588@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2589register.
2590
2591These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2592register that
2593contain a single register class.  If the original reload register (whose
2594class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2595value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2596register.  Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2597Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2598
2599@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2600pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2601Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2602in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2603
2604These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2605registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2606registers.  In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2607would not be helpful.  Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2608the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2609intermediate storage.  This case often occurs between floating-point and
2610general registers.
2611@end defmac
2612
2613@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2614Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2615to some other registers without using memory.  Define this macro on
2616those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2617@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2618class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2619and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2620
2621Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2622@end defmac
2623
2624@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2625Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2626allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2627If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2628defined by this macro.
2629
2630Do not define this macro if you do not define
2631@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2632@end defmac
2633
2634@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2635When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2636registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2637hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2638load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2639same as that of @var{mode}.
2640
2641This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2642bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2643in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2644registers.
2645
2646However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2647the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2648differently than in integer registers.  On those machines, the default
2649widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2650suppress that widening in some cases.  See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2651details.
2652
2653Do not define this macro if you do not define
2654@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2655is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2656@end defmac
2657
2658@defmac SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2659On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2660insns.  Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2661to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2662if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2663insn.
2664
2665Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
2666value on these machines.  When this macro has a nonzero value, the
2667compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2668
2669It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
2670unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2671that can be performed in some cases.  If you do not define this macro
2672with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2673spill registers and print a fatal error message.  For most machines, you
2674should not define this macro at all.
2675@end defmac
2676
2677@defmac CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2678A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2679to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2680registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2681
2682The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2683register and zero otherwise.  On most machines, this default should be
2684used.  Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2685allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2686registers were needed for spill registers.  If this macro returns nonzero
2687for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2688@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2689register.  If there would not be another register available for
2690reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2691the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2692allocation.
2693@end defmac
2694
2695@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2696A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2697of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2698
2699This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2700the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2701should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2702@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2703
2704This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2705in the reload pass.
2706@end defmac
2707
2708@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2709If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2710a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2711
2712For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2713floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2714Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2715does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2716register.  Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2717as below:
2718
2719@smallexample
2720#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2721  (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2722   ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2723@end smallexample
2724@end defmac
2725
2726@node Old Constraints
2727@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2728@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2729@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2730
2731Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2732of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2733Constraints}.  This mechanism is obsolete.  New ports should not use
2734it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2735
2736@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2737For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2738@var{c}, return the length.  This allows you to have register class /
2739constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2740you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2741constraints only.  The definition of this macro should use
2742DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2743to handle specially.
2744There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2745for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2746transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2747return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2748will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2749@end defmac
2750
2751@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2752A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2753letters for register classes.  If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2754value should be the register class corresponding to it.  Otherwise,
2755the value should be @code{NO_REGS}.  The register letter @samp{r},
2756corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2757to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2758@end defmac
2759
2760@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2761Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2762passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2763different variants.
2764@end defmac
2765
2766@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2767A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2768letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2769particular ranges of integer values.  If @var{c} is one of those
2770letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2771the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is
2772not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2773@var{value}.
2774@end defmac
2775
2776@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2777Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2778string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2779between different variants.
2780@end defmac
2781
2782@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2783A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2784letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2785(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2786
2787If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2788@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2789range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is not one of those
2790letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2791
2792@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2793@code{DImode} fixed-point constants.  A given letter can accept either
2794or both kinds of values.  It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2795between these kinds.
2796@end defmac
2797
2798@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2799Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2800string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2801between different variants.
2802@end defmac
2803
2804@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2805A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2806letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2807memory references, for the target machine.  Any letter that is not
2808elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2809@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2810may be used.  Normally this macro will not be defined.
2811
2812If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2813if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2814constraint letter @var{c}.  If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2815constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2816
2817For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2818in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address.  Constraint
2819letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2820@emph{not} contain a symbolic address.  An alternative is specified with
2821a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output.  The next
2822alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2823does not include r0 on the output.
2824@end defmac
2825
2826@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2827Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2828in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2829variants.
2830@end defmac
2831
2832@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2833A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2834letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2835be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2836
2837It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2838at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2839 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2840all those whose address is simply a base register.  This allows the reload
2841pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2842type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2843
2844For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2845memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2846register.  The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2847@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2848If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2849a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2850reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2851into a base register if required.  This is analogous to the way
2852a @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2853@end defmac
2854
2855@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2856A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2857letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2858@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2859be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2860
2861It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2862at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2863a subset of all memory addresses including
2864all those that consist of just a base register.  This allows the reload
2865pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2866type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2867
2868Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2869be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate.  It is treated
2870analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
2871@end defmac
2872
2873@node Stack and Calling
2874@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2875@cindex calling conventions
2876
2877@c prevent bad page break with this line
2878This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2879
2880@menu
2881* Frame Layout::
2882* Exception Handling::
2883* Stack Checking::
2884* Frame Registers::
2885* Elimination::
2886* Stack Arguments::
2887* Register Arguments::
2888* Scalar Return::
2889* Aggregate Return::
2890* Caller Saves::
2891* Function Entry::
2892* Profiling::
2893* Tail Calls::
2894* Stack Smashing Protection::
2895@end menu
2896
2897@node Frame Layout
2898@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2899@cindex stack frame layout
2900@cindex frame layout
2901
2902@c prevent bad page break with this line
2903Here is the basic stack layout.
2904
2905@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2906Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2907pointer to a smaller address.
2908
2909When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
2910compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2911definition used does not matter.
2912@end defmac
2913
2914@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2915This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2916on the stack.  In RTL, a push operation will be
2917@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2918
2919The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2920and @code{POST_INC}.  Which of these is correct depends on
2921the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2922to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2923space for the next item on the stack.
2924
2925The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2926defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2927which is often wrong.
2928@end defmac
2929
2930@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2931Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2932are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2933@end defmac
2934
2935@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2936Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2937addresses on the stack.
2938@end defmac
2939
2940@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2941Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2942
2943If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2944subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2945Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2946value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2947@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2948@c rid of an overfull.  --mew 2feb93
2949@end defmac
2950
2951@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2952Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2953The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2954
2955On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2956is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2957alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2958stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2959@end defmac
2960
2961@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2962Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2963outgoing arguments are placed.  If not specified, the default value of
2964zero is used.  This is the proper value for most machines.
2965
2966If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2967the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2968@end defmac
2969
2970@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2971Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2972address.  On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2973function.
2974
2975If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2976the first argument's address.
2977@end defmac
2978
2979@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2980Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2981on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2982
2983The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2984length of the outgoing arguments.  The default is correct for most
2985machines.  See @file{function.c} for details.
2986@end defmac
2987
2988@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
2989A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
2990stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
2991@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}.  If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
2992default value will be used.  Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
2993elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
2994@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
2995@end defmac
2996
2997@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2998A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2999frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored.  Assume that
3000@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3001itself.
3002
3003If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3004of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3005address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3006@end defmac
3007
3008@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3009If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3010setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed.  For example,
3011on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3012before we can access arbitrary stack frames.  You will seldom need to
3013define this macro.
3014@end defmac
3015
3016@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE ()
3017This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3018the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3019The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3020machines.  One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3021@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3022@end deftypefn
3023
3024@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3025A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3026address for the current frame.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3027of the current frame.  This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3028You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3029as the frame pointer.  Most machines do not need to define it.
3030@end defmac
3031
3032@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3033A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3034address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3035the prologue.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3036frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3037@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3038
3039The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3040@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
3041determine the return address of other frames.
3042@end defmac
3043
3044@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3045Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3046from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3047@end defmac
3048
3049@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3050A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3051incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3052prologue.  This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3053value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3054the stack.
3055
3056You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3057debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3058
3059If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3060@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3061@end defmac
3062
3063@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3064A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3065number that may be used as an alternate return column.  This should
3066be defined only if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3067general register, but an alternate column needs to be used for
3068signal frames.
3069@end defmac
3070
3071@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3072A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3073number that is considered to always have the value zero.  This should
3074only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3075someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3076terminate the stack backtrace.  New ports should avoid this.
3077@end defmac
3078
3079@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3080This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3081contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs.  The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3082info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3083@smallexample
3084(set (reg) (unspec [...] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3085@end smallexample
3086and
3087@smallexample
3088(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [...] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3089@end smallexample
3090to let the backend emit the call frame instructions.  @var{label} is
3091the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3092the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3093@end deftypefn
3094
3095@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3096A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3097from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3098frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue.  The top of
3099the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3100previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3101
3102You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3103debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3104@end defmac
3105
3106@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3107A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3108from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).  The
3109final value should coincide with that calculated by
3110@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.  Which is unfortunately not usable
3111during virtual register instantiation.
3112
3113The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
3114which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3115immediately before the stack frame.  Note that this is not the case on
3116some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3117and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3118
3119You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3120want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3121DWARF 2.
3122@end defmac
3123
3124@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3125If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3126in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3127The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3128@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3129
3130Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3131via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3132variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible.  If this macro is
3133defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3134based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer.  Only one
3135of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3136should be defined.
3137@end defmac
3138
3139@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3140If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3141in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3142in DWARF 2 debug information.  The default is zero.  A different value
3143may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3144@end defmac
3145
3146@node Exception Handling
3147@subsection Exception Handling Support
3148@cindex exception handling
3149
3150@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3151A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3152data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3153@var{N} registers are usable.
3154
3155The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3156handlers via a set of agreed upon registers.  Ideally these registers
3157should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3158but may negatively impact code size.  The target must support at least
31592 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3160
3161You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3162handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3163@end defmac
3164
3165@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3166A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3167to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3168This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3169It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3170
3171Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3172untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3173
3174Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3175by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3176this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3177stack location to be restored in place.  Otherwise, you must define
3178this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3179that provided by DWARF 2.
3180@end defmac
3181
3182@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3183A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3184to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3185return.  It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3186
3187Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3188return address is stored.  For targets that return by popping an
3189address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3190the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3191frame.  If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3192been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3193target call frame.
3194
3195Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3196address calculable during initial code generation.  In that case
3197the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3198
3199If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3200define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3201@end defmac
3202
3203@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3204If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3205to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3206exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3207using it to return to the exception handler.
3208@end defmac
3209
3210@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3211This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3212handling sections.  If at all possible, this should be defined such
3213that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3214and so may be read-only.
3215
3216@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3217@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3218The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3219as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3220
3221If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3222represented directly.
3223@end defmac
3224
3225@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3226This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3227to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3228Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3229be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3230
3231This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3232handled.  @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3233of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3234to be emitted.
3235@end defmac
3236
3237@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3238A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c.  The file
3239so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3240@end defmac
3241
3242@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3243This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
3244code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3245available.  The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3246through signal frames.
3247
3248This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
3249and @file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3250@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{context->ra}
3251for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3252the stack pointer value.  If the frame can be decoded, the register save
3253addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should evaluate to
3254@code{_URC_NO_REASON}.  If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should
3255evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3256
3257For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3258@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3259@end defmac
3260
3261@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3262This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3263call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3264usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3265
3266This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3267@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3268@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3269for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive.  If the
3270@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3271be updated in @var{fs}.
3272@end defmac
3273
3274@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3275A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3276info to be given comdat linkage.  Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3277linkage is necessary.  The default is @code{0}.
3278@end defmac
3279
3280@node Stack Checking
3281@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3282
3283GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
3284the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
3285
3286@enumerate
3287@item
3288If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3289will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
3290appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
3291@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}.  GCC will do not other special
3292processing.
3293
3294@item
3295If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
3296called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
3297pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
3298value against.  You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
3299the stack pointer is out of range.
3300
3301@item
3302If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3303``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3304@end enumerate
3305
3306Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
3307will use the third approach.
3308
3309@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3310A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3311machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if stack checking
3312is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
3313checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
3314The default value of this macro is zero.
3315@end defmac
3316
3317@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
3318An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
3319probe instructions.  You will normally define this macro to be no larger
3320than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area.  The
3321default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
3322@end defmac
3323
3324@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
3325A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
3326as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
3327The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
3328@end defmac
3329
3330@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3331The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
3332for languages where such a recovery is supported.  The default value of
333375 words should be adequate for most machines.
3334@end defmac
3335
3336@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3337The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes.  GCC will generate probe
3338instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3339stack are available.  If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3340checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning.  The
3341default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3342systems.  You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3343@end defmac
3344
3345@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3346GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message.  It
3347represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3348space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3349You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3350use the default of four words.
3351@end defmac
3352
3353@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3354The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3355fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3356@option{-fstack-check}.
3357GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3358normally not need to override that default.
3359@end defmac
3360
3361@need 2000
3362@node Frame Registers
3363@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3364
3365@c prevent bad page break with this line
3366This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3367
3368@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3369The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3370fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}.  On most machines,
3371the hardware determines which register this is.
3372@end defmac
3373
3374@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3375The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3376access automatic variables in the stack frame.  On some machines, the
3377hardware determines which register this is.  On other machines, you can
3378choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3379@end defmac
3380
3381@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3382On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3383offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3384allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3385between these two locations).  On those machines, define
3386@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3387be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3388@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3389used for the frame pointer.
3390
3391You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3392is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3393the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3394completed.  When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3395definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3396@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3397or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3398
3399Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3400@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3401@end defmac
3402
3403@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3404The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3405the function's argument list.  On some machines, this is the same as the
3406frame pointer register.  On some machines, the hardware determines which
3407register this is.  On other machines, you can choose any register you
3408wish for this purpose.  If this is not the same register as the frame
3409pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3410@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3411(@pxref{Elimination}).
3412@end defmac
3413
3414@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3415The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3416access the current function's return address from the stack.  On some
3417machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3418pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer.  This register can be defined
3419to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3420@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3421
3422Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3423address from the stack.
3424@end defmac
3425
3426@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3427@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3428Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer.  If
3429register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3430function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3431number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}.  If
3432these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3433not be defined.
3434
3435The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3436
3437If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3438defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
3439@end defmac
3440
3441@defmac STATIC_CHAIN
3442@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
3443If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
3444@code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3445@code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
3446as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively.  Often the former
3447will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
3448the frame pointer.
3449
3450@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3451@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3452@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3453The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3454@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
3455macros and should be used to refer to those items.
3456
3457If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
3458be defined instead.
3459@end defmac
3460
3461@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3462This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3463saved in a call frame.  This is used to size data structures used in
3464DWARF2 exception handling.
3465
3466Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3467exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3468extensions.  In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3469in the number of hard registers.  Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3470used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3471routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3472registers that are not call-saved.
3473
3474If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3475@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3476@end defmac
3477
3478@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3479
3480This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3481for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3482
3483If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3484@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3485@end defmac
3486
3487@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3488
3489Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3490is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3491Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3492column number to use instead.
3493
3494See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3495@end defmac
3496
3497@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3498
3499Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3500used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3501debug info sections.  Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3502should return the .eh_frame register number.  The default is
3503@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3504
3505@end defmac
3506
3507@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3508
3509Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3510that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3511should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3512.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero).  The default is to
3513return @code{@var{regno}}.
3514
3515@end defmac
3516
3517@node Elimination
3518@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3519
3520@c prevent bad page break with this line
3521This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3522
3523@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3524A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
3525pointer.  This expression is evaluated  in the reload pass.  If its value is
3526nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
3527
3528The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
3529according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
3530constant 1 suffices.  Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
3531with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.  Use 1
3532when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
3533
3534In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3535without a frame pointer.  The compiler recognizes those cases and
3536automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3537@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says.  You don't need to worry about
3538them.
3539
3540In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3541register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3542fixed register.  See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3543@end defmac
3544
3545@findex get_frame_size
3546@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3547A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3548between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3549the function prologue.  The value would be computed from information
3550such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3551registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3552
3553If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3554need not be defined.  Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3555@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3556case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3557@end defmac
3558
3559@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3560If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3561eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.  If it is not
3562defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3563references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3564
3565The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3566of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3567
3568On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3569the compilation is completed.  In such a case, a separate hard register
3570must be used for the argument pointer.  This register can be eliminated by
3571replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3572depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3573
3574In this case, you might specify:
3575@smallexample
3576#define ELIMINABLE_REGS  \
3577@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3578 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3579 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3580@end smallexample
3581
3582Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3583specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3584@end defmac
3585
3586@defmac CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3587A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
3588to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3589@var{to-reg}.  This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3590is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3591preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3592knows about.
3593@end defmac
3594
3595@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3596This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}.  It
3597specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3598registers.  This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3599defined.
3600@end defmac
3601
3602@node Stack Arguments
3603@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3604@cindex arguments on stack
3605@cindex stack arguments
3606
3607The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3608on the stack.  See the following section for other macros that
3609control passing certain arguments in registers.
3610
3611@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (tree @var{fntype})
3612This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3613prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3614passed as an @code{int}.  In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3615cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3616The default is to not promote prototypes.
3617@end deftypefn
3618
3619@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3620A C expression.  If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3621outgoing arguments.
3622If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3623That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3624allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3625it.  When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3626@end defmac
3627
3628@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3629A C expression.  If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3630last to first, rather than from first to last.  If this macro is not
3631defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3632and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3633@end defmac
3634
3635@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3636A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3637stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3638
3639On some machines, the definition
3640
3641@smallexample
3642#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3643@end smallexample
3644
3645@noindent
3646will suffice.  But on other machines, instructions that appear
3647to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3648alignment.  Then the definition should be
3649
3650@smallexample
3651#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3652@end smallexample
3653@end defmac
3654
3655@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3656@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3657A C expression.  If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3658will be computed and placed into the variable
3659@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.  No space will be pushed
3660onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3661increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3662
3663Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3664is not proper.
3665@end defmac
3666
3667@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3668Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3669allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3670registers.
3671
3672The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3673arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3674which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3675
3676This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3677machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3678which.
3679@end defmac
3680@c above is overfull.  not sure what to do.  --mew 5feb93  did
3681@c something, not sure if it looks good.  --mew 10feb93
3682
3683@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3684Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3685reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3686
3687If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3688whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3689@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3690@end defmac
3691
3692@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3693Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3694stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3695@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3696@c overfull.. not as specific, tho.  --mew 5feb93
3697
3698Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3699stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area.  Defining this macro
3700suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3701stack in its natural location.
3702@end defmac
3703
3704@defmac RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3705A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3706arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3707function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3708after the function returns.
3709
3710@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3711the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3712@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3713From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3714
3715@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3716describes the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3717@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3718From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3719arguments (if known).
3720
3721When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3722will contain an identifier node for the library function.  Thus, if
3723you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3724by their names.  Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3725a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3726in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3727
3728@var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3729stack.  If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3730argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3731
3732On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3733of this macro is @var{stack-size}.  On the 68000, using the standard
3734calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3735the macro is always 0 in this case.  But an alternative calling
3736convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3737arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3738nothing (the caller pops all).  When this convention is in use,
3739@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3740number of arguments.
3741@end defmac
3742
3743@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3744A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3745pops off the stack.  It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3746when compiling a function call.
3747
3748@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3749have been accumulated.
3750
3751On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3752that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3753that have been passed to the function.  Since this is a property of the
3754call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3755appropriate.
3756@end defmac
3757
3758@node Register Arguments
3759@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3760@cindex arguments in registers
3761@cindex registers arguments
3762
3763This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3764types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3765the stack.
3766
3767@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3768A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3769in a register, and which register.
3770
3771The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3772arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3773the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3774(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3775which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3776correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3777@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3778occurred.
3779
3780The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3781hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3782argument on the stack.
3783
3784For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3785pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3786
3787The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@.  This is
3788used when an argument is passed in multiple locations.  The mode of the
3789@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument.  The
3790@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3791describes where part of the argument is passed.  In each
3792@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3793register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3794register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is.  The
3795second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3796the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3797As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3798RTX may have a first operand of zero.  This indicates that the entire
3799argument is also stored on the stack.
3800
3801The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3802VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3803pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3804
3805@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3806The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3807where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3808nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead.  This is done
3809by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3810
3811@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3812@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3813You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3814in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3815type that must be passed in the stack.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3816is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3817argument, the compiler will abort.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3818defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3819a register.
3820@end defmac
3821
3822@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type})
3823This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3824solely in registers.  The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3825definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3826documentation.
3827@end deftypefn
3828
3829@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3830Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3831that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3832necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3833argument.
3834
3835For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3836the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3837be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3838where the arguments will arrive.
3839
3840If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3841serves both purposes.
3842@end defmac
3843
3844@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3845This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3846argument that must be put in registers.  The value must be zero for
3847arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3848pushed on the stack.
3849
3850On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3851registers and partially in memory.  On these machines, typically the
3852first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3853on the stack.  If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3854structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3855in registers and the rest must be pushed.  This macro tells the
3856compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
3857
3858@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3859register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3860@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3861@end deftypefn
3862
3863@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3864This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
3865position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference.  This
3866predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
3867passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3868
3869If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3870pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3871The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3872to that type.
3873@end deftypefn
3874
3875@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3876The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3877known to be passed by reference.  The hook should return true if the
3878function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
3879by the caller.
3880
3881For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
3882determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
3883not be generated.
3884
3885The default version of this hook always returns false.
3886@end deftypefn
3887
3888@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3889A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3890@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values.  For some target machines,
3891the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3892argument so far.
3893
3894There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3895arguments that have been passed on the stack.  The compiler has other
3896variables to keep track of that.  For target machines on which all
3897arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3898@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3899should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3900@end defmac
3901
3902@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
3903A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
3904@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list.  The
3905variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.  The value of @var{fntype}
3906is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
3907the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
3908For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
3909declaration node of the function.  @var{fndecl} is also set when
3910@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
3911being compiled.  @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
3912arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
3913parameter, when making a call.  When processing incoming arguments,
3914@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
3915
3916When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3917@var{libname} identifies which one.  It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3918contains the name of the function, as a string.  @var{libname} is 0 when
3919an ordinary C function call is being processed.  Thus, each time this
3920macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3921never both of them at once.
3922@end defmac
3923
3924@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3925Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3926it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3927@code{NULL}.  @var{indirect} would always be zero, too.  If this macro
3928is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
39290)} is used instead.
3930@end defmac
3931
3932@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3933Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3934finding the arguments for the function being compiled.  If this macro is
3935undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3936
3937The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3938with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@.  The
3939argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3940@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3941@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3942@c --mew 5feb93   i switched the order of the sentences.  --mew 10feb93
3943@end defmac
3944
3945@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3946A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3947@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list.  The
3948values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3949Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3950the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3951
3952This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3953on the stack.  The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3954used for arguments without any special help.
3955@end defmac
3956
3957@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3958If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3959to pad out an argument with extra space.  The value should be of type
3960@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3961@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3962
3963The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3964multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3965it.
3966
3967This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3968For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward.  For
3969big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3970constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3971@end defmac
3972
3973@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3974If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3975implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3976next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3977controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.  If this macro is not defined, all such
3978arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3979@end defmac
3980
3981@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
3982Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
3983memory.  @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element.  Defining this
3984macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
3985machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl.  In particular,
3986@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
3987registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register;  For example,
3988a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
3989required.
3990@end defmac
3991
3992@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3993If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3994of an argument with the specified mode and type.  If it is not defined,
3995@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3996@end defmac
3997
3998@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3999A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4000register in which function arguments are sometimes passed.  This does
4001@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4002the structure-value address.  On many machines, no registers can be
4003used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4004stack.
4005@end defmac
4006
4007@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (tree @var{type})
4008This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4009as two scalar parameters.  By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4010arguments into the target's word size.  Some ABIs require complex arguments
4011to be split and treated as their individual components.  For example, on
4012AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4013registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4014point register.
4015
4016The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4017false.
4018@end deftypefn
4019
4020@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4021This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4022The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4023@end deftypefn
4024
4025@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, tree *@var{pre_p}, tree *@var{post_p})
4026This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4027@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}.  The first two parameters correspond to the
4028arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4029@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4030@end deftypefn
4031
4032@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4033Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4034with machine mode @var{mode}.  The default version of this
4035hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4036@end deftypefn
4037
4038@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4039Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4040insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}.  For a scalar mode to be
4041considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4042must work.
4043
4044The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4045required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4046Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4047code in @file{optabs.c}.
4048@end deftypefn
4049
4050@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4051Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4052insns involving vector mode @var{mode}.  At the very least, it
4053must have move patterns for this mode.
4054@end deftypefn
4055
4056@node Scalar Return
4057@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4058@cindex return values in registers
4059@cindex values, returned by functions
4060@cindex scalars, returned as values
4061
4062This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4063values---values that can fit in registers.
4064
4065@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (tree @var{ret_type}, tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4066
4067Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4068returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4069node representing a data type.  @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4070representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4071function being called.  If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4072compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4073Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4074a function returns a value.
4075
4076On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4077(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4078place regardless of mode.)  The value of the expression is usually a
4079@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4080The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4081multiple places.  See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4082@code{parallel} form.
4083
4084If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4085the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4086@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4087
4088If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4089node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4090pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4091convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4092known.
4093
4094Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4095which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4096the caller sees the value.  For such machines, you should return
4097different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4098
4099@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4100aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way.  See
4101@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4102@end deftypefn
4103
4104@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4105This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4106a new target instead.
4107@end defmac
4108
4109@defmac FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4110This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4111a new target instead.
4112@end defmac
4113
4114@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4115A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4116function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.  If the precise function
4117being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
4118(@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4119pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4120convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4121known.
4122
4123Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4124support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4125specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4126compiled.
4127
4128The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
4129data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
4130@end defmac
4131
4132@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4133A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4134register in which the values of called function may come back.
4135
4136A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4137second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4138recognized by this macro.  So for most machines, this definition
4139suffices:
4140
4141@smallexample
4142#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4143@end smallexample
4144
4145If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4146function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4147should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4148@end defmac
4149
4150@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4151Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4152need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4153saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4154@end defmac
4155
4156@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (tree @var{type})
4157This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4158at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4159padded at the least significant end).  You can assume that @var{type}
4160is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4161
4162Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4163be able to hold the complete return value.  For example, if a 1-, 2-
4164or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
41654-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4166@code{SImode} rtx.
4167@end deftypefn
4168
4169@node Aggregate Return
4170@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4171@cindex aggregates as return values
4172@cindex large return values
4173@cindex returning aggregate values
4174@cindex structure value address
4175
4176When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4177cases), the value is not returned according to
4178@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}).  Instead, the
4179caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4180should be stored.  This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4181address}.
4182
4183This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4184memory.
4185
4186@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (tree @var{type}, tree @var{fntype})
4187This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4188function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4189Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4190will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4191libcalls.
4192
4193Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4194by this function.  Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4195takes effect regardless of this macro.  On most systems, it is
4196possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4197definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4198values, and 0 otherwise.
4199
4200Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4201be returned in memory.  You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4202to indicate this.
4203@end deftypefn
4204
4205@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4206Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4207in memory.  Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4208only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4209If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4210and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4211target hook.
4212
4213If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4214@end defmac
4215
4216@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4217This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4218address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4219passed as an ``invisible'' first argument.  Note that @var{fndecl} may
4220be @code{NULL}, for libcalls.  You do not need to define this target
4221hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4222argument.
4223
4224On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4225is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4226caller put it.  This can be due to register windows, or it could
4227be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4228@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4229the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4230the caller.
4231
4232If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4233stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4234@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4235structure value address at the beginning of a function.  If you need
4236to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4237@end deftypefn
4238
4239@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4240Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4241for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4242the address of a static variable containing the value.
4243
4244Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4245pass an address to the subroutine.
4246
4247This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4248nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4249@end defmac
4250
4251@node Caller Saves
4252@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4253
4254If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls.  This
4255makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4256must live across calls.
4257
4258@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4259A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4260a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4261restoring it around each function call.  The expression should be 1 when
4262this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4263
4264If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4265machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4266@end defmac
4267
4268@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4269A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4270of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}.  If
4271@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4272returned.  For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4273will select the smallest suitable mode.
4274@end defmac
4275
4276@node Function Entry
4277@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4278@cindex function entry and exit
4279@cindex prologue
4280@cindex epilogue
4281
4282This section describes the macros that output function entry
4283(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4284
4285@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4286If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4287function.  The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4288initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4289saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4290local variables.  @var{size} is an integer.  @var{file} is a stdio
4291stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4292
4293The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4294macro.  That has already been done when the macro is run.
4295
4296@findex regs_ever_live
4297To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4298@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4299@var{r} is used anywhere within the function.  This implies the function
4300prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4301call-used registers.  (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4302@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4303
4304On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4305not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4306they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4307appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4308registers are used in the function.
4309
4310@findex frame_pointer_needed
4311On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4312function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4313pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise.  To determine whether a
4314frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4315@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 at run
4316time in a function that needs a frame pointer.  @xref{Elimination}.
4317
4318The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4319required for the function.  This stack space consists of the regions
4320listed below.  In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4321order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4322stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4323the highest address if it is not defined).  You can use a different order
4324for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4325compatibility reasons.  Except in cases where required by standard
4326or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4327need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4328@end deftypefn
4329
4330@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4331If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4332prologue.  This should be used when the function prologue is being
4333emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4334emitted.  @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4335@end deftypefn
4336
4337@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4338If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4339epilogue.  This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4340emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4341emitted.  @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4342@end deftypefn
4343
4344@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4345If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4346function.  The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4347registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4348called, and returning control to the caller.  This macro takes the
4349same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4350registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4351@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4352
4353On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4354of returning from the function.  On these machines, give that
4355instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4356@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4357
4358Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4359@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used.  If you want the target
4360switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4361define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4362target switches appropriately.  If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4363condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4364
4365On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4366function exit code must vary accordingly.  Sometimes the code for these
4367two cases is completely different.  To determine whether a frame pointer
4368is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4369@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4370a function that needs a frame pointer.
4371
4372Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4373@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4374The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4375function.  @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4376
4377On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4378others leave that for the caller to do.  For example, the 68020 when
4379given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4380number of arguments.
4381
4382@findex current_function_pops_args
4383Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4384functions pop their own arguments.  @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4385needs to know what was decided.  The variable that is called
4386@code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
4387arguments that a function should pop.  @xref{Scalar Return}.
4388@c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
4389@c tell?  --mew 5feb93
4390@end deftypefn
4391
4392@itemize @bullet
4393@item
4394@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4395A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4396uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4397stack.  (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4398if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4399arguments.  But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4400yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.)  This
4401region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4402registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4403features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4404
4405@item
4406An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4407The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4408the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4409machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4410in the function.  Machines with register windows often do not require
4411a save area.
4412
4413@item
4414A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4415boundary, to contain the local variables of the function.  On some machines,
4416this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4417save area closer to the top of the stack.
4418
4419@item
4420@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4421Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4422@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4423argument lists of the function.  @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4424@end itemize
4425
4426@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4427Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4428instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4429pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4430adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.  The
4431default is 0.
4432
4433Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4434frame pointers are maintained.  It is never safe to delete a final
4435stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4436compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4437@end defmac
4438
4439@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4440Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4441used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern.  The stack and frame
4442pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4443@end defmac
4444
4445@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4446Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4447used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4448on entry to an exception edge.
4449@end defmac
4450
4451@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4452Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4453instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''.  The
4454definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4455representing the number of delay slots there.
4456@end defmac
4457
4458@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4459A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4460slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4461
4462The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4463being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4464eligibility).  It is never negative and is always less than the number
4465of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4466If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4467may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot.  Also, other insns may
4468(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4469slot.
4470
4471@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4472@findex final_scan_insn
4473The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4474list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4475@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}.  The insn for the first
4476delay slot comes first in the list.  Your definition of the macro
4477@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4478outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4479@code{final_scan_insn}.
4480
4481You need not define this macro if you did not define
4482@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4483@end defmac
4484
4485@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4486A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4487function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4488inheritance.  The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4489adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4490the real function.
4491
4492First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4493contains the incoming first argument.  Assume that this argument
4494contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4495in C++.  This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4496e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc.  The addition must preserve the values of
4497all other incoming arguments.
4498
4499Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4500made after adding @code{delta}.  In particular, if @var{p} is the
4501adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4502
4503@smallexample
4504p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4505@end smallexample
4506
4507After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4508@code{FUNCTION_DECL}.  This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4509not touch the return address.  Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4510return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4511
4512The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4513the adjusted first argument.  This macro is responsible for emitting all
4514of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4515and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4516
4517The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant.  (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4518have already been extracted from it.)  It might possibly be useful on
4519some targets, but probably not.
4520
4521If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4522front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4523@var{function} instead of jumping to it.  The generic approach does
4524not support varargs.
4525@end deftypefn
4526
4527@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4528A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4529to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4530arguments it is passed, and false otherwise.  In the latter case, the
4531generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4532previously exposed.
4533@end deftypefn
4534
4535@node Profiling
4536@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4537@cindex profiling, code generation
4538
4539These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4540
4541@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4542A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4543assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4544
4545@findex mcount
4546The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4547your operating system environment, not by GCC@.  To figure them out,
4548compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4549compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4550
4551Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4552variable to be loaded into some register.  The name of this variable is
4553@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4554the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4555@end defmac
4556
4557@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4558A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4559code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4560not support profiling.
4561@end defmac
4562
4563@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4564Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4565@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4566allocated for each function.  This is true for almost all modern
4567implementations.  If you define this macro, you must not use the
4568@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4569@end defmac
4570
4571@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4572Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4573the function prologue.  Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4574@end defmac
4575
4576@node Tail Calls
4577@subsection Permitting tail calls
4578@cindex tail calls
4579
4580@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4581True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4582call expression @var{exp}.  @var{decl} will be the called function,
4583or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4584
4585It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4586tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4587during PIC compilation.  The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4588as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4589``normal'' call.  The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4590may vary greatly between different architectures.
4591@end deftypefn
4592
4593@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap *@var{regs})
4594Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4595function.  This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4596cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4597registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4598TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4599FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4600@end deftypefn
4601
4602@node Stack Smashing Protection
4603@subsection Stack smashing protection
4604@cindex stack smashing protection
4605
4606@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4607This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4608for the stack protection guard.  This variable is initialized by the
4609runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4610that is placed at the top of the local stack frame.  The type of this
4611variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4612
4613The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4614@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4615@end deftypefn
4616
4617@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4618This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4619stack protect guard variable has been modified.  This expression should
4620involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4621
4622The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4623@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments.  This function is
4624normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4625@end deftypefn
4626
4627@node Varargs
4628@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4629@cindex varargs implementation
4630
4631GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4632@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4633on the stack.  Other machines require their own implementations of
4634varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4635conditionals to include it.
4636
4637ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4638the calling convention for @code{va_start}.  The traditional
4639implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4640to store the argument pointer.  The ISO implementation of
4641@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument.  The user is
4642supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4643
4644However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument.  The way to find
4645the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4646below.
4647
4648@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4649Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4650that the varargs mechanism can access them.  Both ISO and traditional
4651versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4652you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4653
4654On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4655control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  On
4656other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4657found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4658
4659Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4660beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4661@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4662This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4663to use them for its own purposes.
4664@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4665@c 10feb93
4666@end defmac
4667
4668@defmac __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4669Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4670registers.
4671
4672In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4673arguments, each for a particular category of data types.  (For example,
4674on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4675arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4676To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4677have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4678registers in each category have been used so far
4679
4680@code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4681@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4682with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access.  Thus, the
4683value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4684
4685Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4686of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4687value in the @code{va_list} object.  This is because @code{va_list} will
4688have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4689values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4690@end defmac
4691
4692@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4693This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4694arguments.  It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4695argument, as type @code{void *}.  If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4696returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4697argument.  Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4698fetching arguments from the stack.  Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4699verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4700of the current function.
4701@end defmac
4702
4703@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4704Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4705passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4706has to embody these conventions.  The easiest way to categorize the
4707specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4708with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4709
4710@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4711considering only its data type.  It returns an integer describing what
4712kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4713
4714The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4715interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4716@end defmac
4717
4718These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4719
4720@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
4721If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4722@code{__builtin_saveregs}.  This code will be moved to the very
4723beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.  The
4724return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4725to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4726@end deftypefn
4727
4728@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
4729This target hook offers an alternative to using
4730@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4731@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  Use it to store the anonymous
4732register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4733have been passed consecutively on the stack.  Once this is done, you can
4734use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4735pass all their arguments on the stack.
4736
4737The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4738structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4739named arguments.  The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4740last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4741
4742The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4743argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4744store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4745variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}.  The value that you
4746store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4747frame.
4748
4749Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4750compile time without knowing their data types,
4751@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4752have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
4753for all data types.
4754
4755If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4756arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time.  This
4757happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4758end of the source file.  The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4759not generate any instructions in this case.
4760@end deftypefn
4761
4762@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
4763Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
4764argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4765
4766This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4767is set for varargs and stdarg functions.  If this hook returns
4768@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4769arguments, and false for unnamed arguments.  If it returns @code{false},
4770but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
4771then all arguments are treated as named.  Otherwise, all named arguments
4772except the last are treated as named.
4773
4774You need not define this hook if it always returns zero.
4775@end deftypefn
4776
4777@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4778If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4779@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4780@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4781defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
4782@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
4783Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
4784@end deftypefn
4785
4786@node Trampolines
4787@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4788@cindex trampolines for nested functions
4789@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4790
4791A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4792when the address of a nested function is taken.  It normally resides on
4793the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.  These macros
4794tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4795trampoline.
4796
4797The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4798address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4799the nested function.  On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4800two instructions, a move immediate and a jump.  Then the two addresses
4801exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.  On RISC
4802machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4803two parts.  Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4804operands.
4805
4806The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4807parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4808immediate operands of the instructions.  On a CISC machine, this is
4809simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4810proper offset from the start of the trampoline.  On a RISC machine, it
4811may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4812separately.
4813
4814@defmac TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4815A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4816block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline.  This
4817code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4818automatically.
4819
4820If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4821for the target.  Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4822code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4823to generate it on the spot.
4824@end defmac
4825
4826@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4827Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
4828(@pxref{Sections}).  The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
4829@end defmac
4830
4831@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4832A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4833@end defmac
4834
4835@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4836Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4837
4838If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4839is used for aligning trampolines.
4840@end defmac
4841
4842@defmac INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4843A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4844@var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4845an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4846RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4847when it is called.
4848@end defmac
4849
4850@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4851A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4852the address of the trampoline.  Its argument contains the address that
4853was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}.  In case the address to be
4854used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4855the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4856@var{addr}.  If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4857function calls.
4858
4859@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4860@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4861If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4862a stack slot.  This default is right for most machines.  The exceptions
4863are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4864area.  On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4865using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4866and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4867
4868@var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4869describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4870the function which the trampoline is for.  The stack slot for the
4871trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function.  Other
4872allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4873information.
4874@end defmac
4875
4876Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4877separate instruction and data caches.  Writing into a stack location
4878fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4879jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4880
4881Here are two possible solutions.  One is to clear the relevant parts of
4882the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up.  The other is to
4883make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4884subroutine.  The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4885latter makes initialization faster.
4886
4887To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4888the following macro.
4889
4890@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4891If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4892cache} in the specified interval.  The definition of this macro would
4893typically be a series of @code{asm} statements.  Both @var{beg} and
4894@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
4895@end defmac
4896
4897The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
4898before calling the trampoline.  To implement this requirement, define
4899the following macro.
4900
4901@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
4902Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
4903code located on the stack.  The macro should expand to a series of C
4904file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
4905named @code{__enable_execute_stack}.  The target is responsible for
4906emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
4907@code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE} macro.
4908@end defmac
4909
4910To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro.  In addition,
4911you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4912cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4913beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4914its cache line.  Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4915
4916@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4917Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4918work.  The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4919which will be compiled with GCC@.  They go in a library function named
4920@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4921
4922If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4923C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4924special label of your own in the assembler code.  Use one @code{asm}
4925statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4926global.  Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4927special assembler code.
4928@end defmac
4929
4930@node Library Calls
4931@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4932@cindex library subroutine names
4933@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4934
4935@c prevent bad page break with this line
4936Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4937
4938@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4939This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
4940expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a.  It can be used to
4941provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
4942are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
4943@end defmac
4944
4945@findex init_one_libfunc
4946@findex set_optab_libfunc
4947@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
4948This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
4949existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
4950@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
4951@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
4952library routines.
4953
4954The default is to do nothing.  Most ports don't need to define this hook.
4955@end deftypefn
4956
4957@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4958This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
4959implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
4960mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
4961return a tristate.
4962
4963GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
4964comparison operators, so the default returns false always.  Most ports
4965don't need to define this macro.
4966@end defmac
4967
4968@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
4969This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
4970functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
4971operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
4972and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
4973If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
4974@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2.  If the target uses the routines
4975in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
4976@end defmac
4977
4978@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
4979@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
4980@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
4981@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
4982@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
4983Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
4984library to provide floating point emulation.
4985
4986In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
4987@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
4988else call that function from its version of that hook.  It is defined
4989in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
4990architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file.  See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
4991an example.
4992
4993If this macro is defined, the
4994@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
4995false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
4996@end defmac
4997
4998@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4999@findex matherr
5000@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5001The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5002expression.  If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5003deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly.  Look in
5004@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5005system.
5006
5007If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5008domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5009error.  If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5010there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5011that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5012@end defmac
5013
5014@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5015@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5016Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5017refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}.  (On certain systems,
5018@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.)  If you don't define this
5019macro, a reasonable default is used.
5020@end defmac
5021
5022@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5023@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5024When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5025@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard.  The
5026default is nonzero that should be proper value for most modern systems, however
5027number of existing systems lacks support for these functions in the runtime so
5028they needs this macro to be redefined to 0.
5029@end defmac
5030
5031@node Addressing Modes
5032@section Addressing Modes
5033@cindex addressing modes
5034
5035@c prevent bad page break with this line
5036This is about addressing modes.
5037
5038@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5039@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5040@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5041@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5042A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5043pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5044@end defmac
5045
5046@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5047@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5048A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5049post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5050the size of the memory operand.
5051@end defmac
5052
5053@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5054@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5055A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5056post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5057@end defmac
5058
5059@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5060A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5061is a valid address.  On most machines, this can be defined as
5062@code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
5063in which constant addresses are supported.
5064@end defmac
5065
5066@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5067@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5068accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5069known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5070expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5071@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5072@end defmac
5073
5074@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5075A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5076memory address.  Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5077the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
5078accept.
5079@end defmac
5080
5081@defmac GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5082A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
5083executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
5084target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5085
5086It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
5087subroutines for this one.  Otherwise it may be too complicated to
5088understand.
5089
5090This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
5091non-strict one.  The strict variant is used in the reload pass.  It
5092must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
5093allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference.  In
5094contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
5095with no hard register must be rejected.
5096
5097The non-strict variant is used in other passes.  It must be defined to
5098accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5099register is required.
5100
5101@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5102Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5103macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}.  You should use an
5104@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
5105in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5106
5107Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
5108for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
5109among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
5110Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
5111levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
5112
5113Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5114and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5115constant.  Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5116specifically as legitimate addresses.  Normally you would simply
5117recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5118
5119Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5120sums that are not marked with  @code{const}.  It assumes that a naked
5121@code{plus} indicates indexing.  If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5122naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5123be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5124
5125@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5126On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5127the section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the
5128target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5129into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  When you see a
5130@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5131@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section.  @xref{Assembler
5132Format}.
5133@end defmac
5134
5135@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5136A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
5137This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
5138
5139It is always safe for this macro to not be defined.  It exists so
5140that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5141
5142The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5143a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5144@end defmac
5145
5146@defmac LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
5147A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
5148memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a
5149C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
5150
5151@smallexample
5152GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
5153@end smallexample
5154
5155@noindent
5156to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
5157
5158@findex break_out_memory_refs
5159@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5160and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5161@var{x}.
5162
5163The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
5164@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5165should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5166
5167It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5168address.  The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases.  In
5169fact, it is safe to omit this macro.  But often a
5170machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5171@end defmac
5172
5173@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5174A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5175that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5176@var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5177It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5178performance reasons.
5179
5180For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5181reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5182registers into a register.  On the other hand, for number of RISC
5183processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5184needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot.  By defining
5185@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5186generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5187be shared.
5188
5189@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution.  It is necessary
5190to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5191and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5192of reload internals.
5193
5194@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5195previous invocation of this macro.  If it fails to handle such addresses
5196then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5197
5198@findex push_reload
5199The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5200need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5201suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5202
5203The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5204@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5205should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5206This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5207@code{push_reload}.
5208
5209@findex strict_memory_address_p
5210The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5211the address has become legitimate.
5212
5213@findex copy_rtx
5214If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5215this is to use @code{copy_rtx}.  Note, however, that is unshares only a
5216single level of rtl.  Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5217top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5218It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5219address;  but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5220@end defmac
5221
5222@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5223A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5224@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5225different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5226reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5227but not others.
5228
5229Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5230effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5231of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
5232addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5233
5234You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5235@end defmac
5236
5237@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5238A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5239an immediate operand on the target machine.  You can assume that
5240@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.  In fact,
5241@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5242anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5243@end defmac
5244
5245@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5246This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5247@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5248macros.  Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5249references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5250addressing modes.  This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5251the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5252into their original form.
5253@end deftypefn
5254
5255@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (rtx @var{x})
5256This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5257should not) be spilled to the constant pool.  The default version of
5258this hook returns false.
5259
5260The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5261deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5262from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5263holding the constant.  This restriction is often true of addresses
5264of TLS symbols for various targets.
5265@end deftypefn
5266
5267@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5268This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5269be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.  @var{mode} is the mode
5270of @var{x}.
5271
5272The default version returns false for all constants.
5273@end deftypefn
5274
5275@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5276This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5277address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5278used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5279@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5280
5281The autovectrizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5282@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5283the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5284@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5285two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5286@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5287the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5288from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5289@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5290@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5291@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5292
5293If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5294to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5295use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5296@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5297should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5298described above.
5299If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5300the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5301log2(@var{VS})-1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5302@end deftypefn
5303
5304@node Anchored Addresses
5305@section Anchored Addresses
5306@cindex anchored addresses
5307@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5308
5309GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5310For example, if we have:
5311
5312@smallexample
5313static int a, b, c;
5314int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5315@end smallexample
5316
5317the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5318addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}.  On some targets,
5319it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5320the three variables relative to it.  The equivalent pseudocode would
5321be something like:
5322
5323@smallexample
5324int foo (void)
5325@{
5326  register int *xr = &x;
5327  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5328@}
5329@end smallexample
5330
5331(which isn't valid C).  We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5332``section anchors''.  Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5333
5334The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5335in order to make effective use of section anchors.  It won't use
5336section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5337or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5338
5339@deftypevar {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5340The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5341On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5342applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5343for every mode.  The default value is 0.
5344@end deftypevar
5345
5346@deftypevar {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5347Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5348offset that should be applied to section anchors.  The default
5349value is 0.
5350@end deftypevar
5351
5352@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5353Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5354@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5355The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5356of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5357
5358If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5359it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5360If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5361is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5362@end deftypefn
5363
5364@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (rtx @var{x})
5365Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5366@var{x}.  You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5367@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5368
5369The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5370intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5371or target-specific sections.
5372@end deftypefn
5373
5374@node Condition Code
5375@section Condition Code Status
5376@cindex condition code status
5377
5378@c prevent bad page break with this line
5379This describes the condition code status.
5380
5381@findex cc_status
5382The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5383describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5384the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by).  This
5385variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5386currently based, and several standard flags.
5387
5388Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5389description header file.  It can also add additional machine-specific
5390information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5391
5392@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5393C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5394component of @code{cc_status}.  It defaults to @code{int}.
5395
5396This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5397@end defmac
5398
5399@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5400A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5401The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5402the field anyway.  If you want to use the field, you should probably
5403define this macro to initialize it.
5404
5405This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5406@end defmac
5407
5408@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5409A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5410appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}.  It is
5411this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5412code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5413set @code{(cc0)}.
5414
5415This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5416
5417If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5418other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5419invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5420reflecting.  For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5421registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5422@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5423insns.  But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5424based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5425value in @samp{a4}.  Although the condition code is not changed by
5426this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5427@samp{a4@@(102)}.  Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5428@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5429condition code value.
5430
5431The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5432with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5433@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5434constants which are just the operands.  The RTL structure of these
5435insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do.  What
5436@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5437@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5438
5439A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5440that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5441@samp{cc}.  This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5442two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5443@end defmac
5444
5445@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5446Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
5447operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}.  For
5448example, on the SPARC, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
5449@pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
5450definition)
5451
5452@smallexample
5453#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5454  (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT          \
5455   ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode)    \
5456   : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS    \
5457       || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5458      ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5459@end smallexample
5460
5461You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5462in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5463@end defmac
5464
5465@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5466On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5467convert an invalid comparison into a valid one.  For example, the Alpha
5468does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5469comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5470
5471On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5472required conversions.  @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5473and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5474comparison, respectively.  You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5475@var{op1} as required.
5476
5477GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5478valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5479@file{md} file.
5480
5481You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5482code or operands.
5483@end defmac
5484
5485@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5486A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5487comparison whose mode is @var{mode}.  If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5488can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5489then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5490
5491You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5492floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5493For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5494inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5495
5496@smallexample
5497#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE)  ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5498@end smallexample
5499@end defmac
5500
5501@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5502A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5503comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}.  The macro is used only in case
5504@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero.  Define this macro in case
5505machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals.  For
5506instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5507freely convert unordered compares to ordered one.  Then definition may look
5508like:
5509
5510@smallexample
5511#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5512   ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5513    : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5514@end smallexample
5515@end defmac
5516
5517@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
5518A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
5519@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
5520versa.  Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
5521predicates that cannot be reversed safely.  There is no need to validate
5522that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
5523If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
5524
5525@smallexample
5526#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
5527   (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
5528@end smallexample
5529@end defmac
5530
5531@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *, unsigned int *)
5532On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
5533register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
5534regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
5535hard register is set to a common value.  Use this hook to enable a
5536small pass which optimizes such cases.  This hook should return true
5537to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
5538arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
5539When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
5540integer pointed to by the second argument should be set to
5541@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
5542
5543The default version of this hook returns false.
5544@end deftypefn
5545
5546@deftypefn {Target Hook} enum machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode, enum machine_mode)
5547On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
5548@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
5549validly done in more than one mode.  On such a system, define this
5550target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
5551both comparisons may be validly done.  If there is no such mode,
5552return @code{VOIDmode}.
5553
5554The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
5555same.  If they are, it returns that mode.  If they are different, it
5556returns @code{VOIDmode}.
5557@end deftypefn
5558
5559@node Costs
5560@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5561@cindex costs of instructions
5562@cindex relative costs
5563@cindex speed of instructions
5564
5565These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5566on the target machine.
5567
5568@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5569A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5570register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes are
5571expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  A
5572value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5573that.
5574
5575It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5576same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5577registers if they are not general registers.
5578
5579If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5580hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5581classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5582constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5583allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
5584if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5585@end defmac
5586
5587@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5588A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5589register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5590is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in.  This cost
5591is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.  If moving between
5592registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5593should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5594
5595If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5596the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5597needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5598between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5599more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5600reflect the actual cost of the move.
5601
5602GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5603secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
5604a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
5605secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
56064 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5607value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
5608are the same as to this macro.
5609@end defmac
5610
5611@defmac BRANCH_COST
5612A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction.  A value of 1 is
5613the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5614@end defmac
5615
5616Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5617but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5618ordinarily expect.
5619
5620@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5621Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5622than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5623faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5624require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5625between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5626
5627When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5628finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5629load will be used if alignment permits.  Unless bytes accesses are
5630faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5631may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5632other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5633@end defmac
5634
5635@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5636Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5637@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5638than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5639handler.
5640
5641When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
5642@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
5643moves.  This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5644Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
5645cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5646
5647If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined.  If
5648this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
5649@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
5650@end defmac
5651
5652@defmac MOVE_RATIO
5653The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5654which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5655string move insn or a library call.  Increasing the value will always
5656make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5657
5658Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5659@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5660the number of such sequences.
5661
5662If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5663@end defmac
5664
5665@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5666A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5667copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5668will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5669than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5670@end defmac
5671
5672@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5673A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5674a load or store used to copy memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5675@end defmac
5676
5677@defmac CLEAR_RATIO
5678The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
5679of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
5680or a library call.  Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
5681eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5682
5683If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5684@end defmac
5685
5686@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5687A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
5688to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
5689will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5690than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
5691@end defmac
5692
5693@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5694A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
5695used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some other
5696mechanism will be used.  Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when storing
5697values other than constant zero and by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
5698when called with a constant source string.
5699Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5700than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5701@end defmac
5702
5703@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5704A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5705thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5706@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5707@end defmac
5708
5709@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5710A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5711thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5712@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5713@end defmac
5714
5715@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5716A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5717thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5718@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5719@end defmac
5720
5721@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5722A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5723thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5724@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5725@end defmac
5726
5727@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5728A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5729thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5730@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5731@end defmac
5732
5733@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5734A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5735thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5736@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5737@end defmac
5738
5739@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5740This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5741thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5742@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5743@end defmac
5744
5745@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5746This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5747thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5748@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5749@end defmac
5750
5751@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5752Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5753function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5754@end defmac
5755
5756@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
5757Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
5758@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal.  This macro defaults to true if
5759@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
5760@end defmac
5761
5762@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total})
5763This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
5764
5765The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
5766available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
5767in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}.  @var{code} is the
5768expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
5769@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5770
5771In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
5772@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5773instructions.
5774
5775On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
5776for the cost of the expression.  The hook should modify this value as
5777necessary.  Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
5778for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
5779operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
5780
5781When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{optimize_size} is
5782nonzero, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
5783size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
5784
5785The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
5786processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
5787@end deftypefn
5788
5789@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address})
5790This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5791@var{address}.  If not defined, the cost is computed from
5792the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
5793
5794For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5795true cost of the addressing mode.  However, on RISC machines, all
5796instructions normally have the same length and execution time.  Hence
5797all addresses will have equal costs.
5798
5799In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5800the lowest cost will be used.  If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5801cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5802
5803For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5804and a constant is used twice in the same basic block.  When this macro
5805is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5806references will be indirect through that register.  On machines where
5807the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5808that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5809instruction and possibly require an additional register.  Proper
5810specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5811
5812This hook is never called with an invalid address.
5813
5814On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5815cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5816@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
5817be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
5818@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner.  This effect
5819should be considered in the definition of this macro.  Equivalent costs
5820should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
5821registers on machines with lots of registers.
5822@end deftypefn
5823
5824@node Scheduling
5825@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
5826
5827The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
5828adjustment in order to produce good code.  GCC provides several target
5829hooks for this purpose.  It is usually enough to define just a few of
5830them: try the first ones in this list first.
5831
5832@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
5833This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
5834issue at the same time on the target machine.  The default is one.
5835Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
5836an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
5837constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
5838hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
5839This value must be constant over the entire compilation.  If you need
5840it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
5841@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
5842@end deftypefn
5843
5844@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
5845This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
5846from the ready list.  It should return the number of insns which can
5847still be issued in the current cycle.  The default is
5848@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
5849@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
5850You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
5851than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
5852@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5853debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5854@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{insn} is the instruction that
5855was scheduled.
5856@end deftypefn
5857
5858@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
5859This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
5860relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
5861dependence @var{link}.  It should return the new value.  The default
5862is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}.  This can be used for example
5863to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
5864that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
5865data-dependence.  If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
5866description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
5867output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
5868times of the first and the second insns.  If these values are not
5869acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too.  See also
5870@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
5871@end deftypefn
5872
5873@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
5874This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
5875@var{insn}.  It should return the new priority.  Increase the priority to
5876execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
5877later.  Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
5878scheduling priorities of insns.
5879@end deftypefn
5880
5881@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
5882This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
5883list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
5884combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
5885@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5886debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5887@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
5888list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.  @var{n_readyp} is
5889a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list.  The scheduler
5890reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
5891@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0].  @var{clock}
5892is the timer tick of the scheduler.  You may modify the ready list and
5893the number of ready insns.  The return value is the number of insns that
5894can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}.  See also
5895@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
5896@end deftypefn
5897
5898@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
5899Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time.  That
5900function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle.  This one
5901is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
5902@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
5903return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.  Defining
5904this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
5905scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
5906cycle.  These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
5907@end deftypefn
5908
5909@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
5910This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
5911chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
5912correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain.  For
5913example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
5914analysis of dependencies.  This hook can use backward and forward
5915dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
5916calculated.
5917@end deftypefn
5918
5919@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
5920This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
5921instructions that are to be scheduled.  @var{file} is either a null
5922pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose}
5923is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5924@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
5925region that can be live at the same time.  This can be used to allocate
5926scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
5927@end deftypefn
5928
5929@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5930This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
5931instructions that are to be scheduled.  It can be used to perform
5932cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks.  @var{file}
5933is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
5934to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5935@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5936@end deftypefn
5937
5938@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
5939This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
5940@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
5941@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5942@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
5943@end deftypefn
5944
5945@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5946This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
5947@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
5948@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5949@end deftypefn
5950
5951@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5952The hook returns an RTL insn.  The automaton state used in the
5953pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
5954when the new simulated processor cycle starts.  Usage of the hook may
5955simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
5956processors.  If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
5957based pipeline description.  The default is not to change the state
5958when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
5959@end deftypefn
5960
5961@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5962The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5963@end deftypefn
5964
5965@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5966The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
5967to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
5968simulated processor cycle finishes.
5969@end deftypefn
5970
5971@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5972The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
5973used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5974@end deftypefn
5975
5976@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
5977This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
5978for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler.  Usually the scheduler
5979chooses the first insn from the queue.  If the hook returns a positive
5980value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
5981@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
5982subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
5983maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle.  For the
5984@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
5985packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn.  Of course, if the
5986rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
5987
5988This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
5989processors.  Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
5990with 3 pipelines.  Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
5991@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
5992@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}.  The
5993processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
5994@var{B}.  In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
5995until the next cycle.  If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
5996the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
5997
5998Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
5999pipeline hazard recognizer.  We try quickly and easy many insn
6000schedules to choose the best one.
6001
6002The default is no multipass scheduling.
6003@end deftypefn
6004
6005@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx)
6006
6007This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6008considered for the multipass insn scheduling.  If the hook returns
6009zero for insn passed as the parameter, the insn will be not chosen to
6010be issued.
6011
6012The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6013@end deftypefn
6014
6015@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *, int, rtx, int, int, int *)
6016
6017This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing insn passed
6018as the third parameter on given cycle.  If the hook returns nonzero,
6019the insn is not issued on given processors cycle.  Instead of that,
6020the processor cycle is advanced.  If the value passed through the last
6021parameter is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6022start as usually.  The first parameter passes file for debugging
6023output.  The second one passes the scheduler verbose level of the
6024debugging output.  The forth and the fifth parameter values are
6025correspondingly processor cycle on which the previous insn has been
6026issued and the current processor cycle.
6027@end deftypefn
6028
6029@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (rtx @var{insn1}, rtx @var{insn2}, rtx @var{dep_link}, int @var{dep_cost}, int @var{distance})
6030This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6031the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6032are involved in the dependence too close to one another.  The parameters
6033to this hook are as follows:  The second parameter @var{insn2} is dependent
6034upon the first parameter @var{insn1}.  The dependence between @var{insn1}
6035and @var{insn2} is represented by the third parameter @var{dep_link}.  The
6036fourth parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the dependence, and the fifth
6037parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6038The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6039insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6040and @code{false} otherwise.
6041
6042Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6043where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6044delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6045that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6046important.  In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6047closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance;  however,
6048not in cases of "costly dependences", which this hooks allows to define.
6049@end deftypefn
6050
6051@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST_2 (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{dep_type}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6052This hook is a modified version of @samp{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST}.  Instead
6053of passing dependence as a second parameter, it passes a type of that
6054dependence.  This is useful to calculate cost of dependence between insns
6055not having the corresponding link.  If @samp{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST_2} is
6056defined it is used instead of @samp{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST}.
6057@end deftypefn
6058
6059@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6060This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6061the instruction stream.  The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6062per instruction data structures.
6063@end deftypefn
6064
6065@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6066This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6067speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6068The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6069version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6070pattern.  The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6071or -1, if it doesn't.  @var{request} describes the type of requested
6072speculation.  If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6073the generated speculative pattern.
6074@end deftypefn
6075
6076@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (rtx @var{insn})
6077This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6078for @var{insn}.  It should return nonzero, if the corresponding check
6079instruction should branch to recovery code, or zero otherwise.
6080@end deftypefn
6081
6082@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6083This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6084check instruction.  If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6085speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6086@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6087be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6088recovery code (a simple check).  If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6089a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6090@var{insn} should be generated.  In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6091@end deftypefn
6092
6093@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (rtx @var{insn})
6094This hook is used as a workaround for
6095@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6096called on the first instruction of the ready list.  The hook is used to
6097discard speculative instruction that stand first in the ready list from
6098being scheduled on the current cycle.  For non-speculative instructions,
6099the hook should always return nonzero.  For example, in the ia64 backend
6100the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6101is nearly full.
6102@end deftypefn
6103
6104@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (unsigned int *@var{flags}, spec_info_t @var{spec_info})
6105This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6106enabled/used.  @var{flags} initially may have either the SCHED_RGN or SCHED_EBB
6107bit set.  This denotes the scheduler pass for which the data should be
6108provided.  The target backend should modify @var{flags} by modifying
6109the bits corresponding to the following features: USE_DEPS_LIST, USE_GLAT,
6110DETACH_LIFE_INFO, and DO_SPECULATION.  For the DO_SPECULATION feature
6111an additional structure @var{spec_info} should be filled by the target.
6112The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6113@end deftypefn
6114
6115@node Sections
6116@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6117@c the above section title is WAY too long.  maybe cut the part between
6118@c the (...)?  --mew 10feb93
6119
6120An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6121data.  In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6122section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6123section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6124section}, which holds uninitialized data.  Some systems have other kinds
6125of sections.
6126
6127@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6128@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6129The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6130is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6131as described below.  The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6132initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6133They may however depend on command-line flags.
6134
6135@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6136use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6137to be string literals.
6138
6139Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6140section is selected.  If your assembler falls into this category, you
6141should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6142@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6143
6144You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6145@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6146in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}.  The same is true of
6147@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  If you do not
6148create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6149reuse @code{text_section}.
6150
6151All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6152if the target does not provide them.
6153
6154@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6155A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6156assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6157Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6158@end defmac
6159
6160@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6161If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6162frequently executed functions of the program.  If not defined, GCC will provide
6163a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6164@end defmac
6165
6166@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6167If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6168executed functions in the program.
6169@end defmac
6170
6171@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6172A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6173assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6174data.  Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6175@end defmac
6176
6177@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6178If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6179containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6180initialized, writable small data.
6181@end defmac
6182
6183@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6184A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6185assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6186data.
6187@end defmac
6188
6189@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6190If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6191containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6192uninitialized global data.  If not defined, and neither
6193@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6194uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6195@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6196used.
6197@end defmac
6198
6199@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6200If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6201containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6202uninitialized, writable small data.
6203@end defmac
6204
6205@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6206If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6207containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6208initialization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6209not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6210variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6211@end defmac
6212
6213@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6214If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6215containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6216finalization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6217not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6218variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6219@end defmac
6220
6221@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6222If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6223containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6224part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
6225defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
6226both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6227@end defmac
6228
6229@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6230If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6231containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6232part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
6233defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
6234both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6235@end defmac
6236
6237@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6238If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6239via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6240the text section.  This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6241@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6242to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6243sections.  By default, this macro uses a simple function call.  Some
6244ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6245registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6246constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6247@end defmac
6248
6249@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6250If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6251variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go.  This is useful
6252when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6253you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6254they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6255expects.  For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6256MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6257require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6258to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6259access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6260@end defmac
6261
6262@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6263If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6264arbitrary boundary.  This is used to force all fragments of the
6265@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6266and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6267@end defmac
6268
6269@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6270Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6271tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6272section, along with the assembler instructions.  Otherwise, the
6273readonly data section is used.
6274
6275This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6276@end defmac
6277
6278@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
6279Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6280@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6281of its own that you need to create.
6282
6283GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6284any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6285described below.
6286@end deftypefn
6287
6288@deftypefn {Target Hook} TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
6289Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6290selecting sections.  Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6291should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6292local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6293
6294The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6295is in effect, and 0 otherwise.  The hook is typically redefined
6296when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6297in read-only sections even in executables.
6298@end deftypefn
6299
6300@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
6301Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed.  You can
6302assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6303some sort.  @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6304requires link-time relocations.  Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6305local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6306@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6307
6308The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6309variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6310
6311See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6312@end deftypefn
6313
6314@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6315Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6316for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6317
6318In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6319function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6320it is unlikely to be called.
6321@end defmac
6322
6323@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
6324Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6325and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6326As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6327the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6328
6329The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6330ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol.  For
6331example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6332Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6333@end deftypefn
6334
6335@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
6336Return the readonly data section associated with
6337@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6338The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6339the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6340if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6341otherwise.
6342@end deftypefn
6343
6344@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
6345Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
6346should be placed.  You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
6347constant in RTL@.  The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
6348case of a @code{const_int} rtx.  @var{align} is the constant alignment
6349in bits.
6350
6351The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6352constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6353else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6354@end deftypefn
6355
6356@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
6357Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
6358treated differently depending on something about the variable or
6359function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
6360
6361The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
6362@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
6363an entry in the constant pool.  In either case, @var{rtl} is the
6364rtl in question.  Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
6365in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
6366
6367In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
6368a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}.  Most decls
6369will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed.  Global
6370register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
6371rtl.  (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
6372leave it alone.)
6373
6374The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
6375that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl.  It will
6376be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
6377declarations.  Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
6378declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
6379@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
6380
6381@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6382The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
6383@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
6384Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
6385encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
6386discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
6387
6388The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
6389in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
6390@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.  Check whether the default does what you need
6391before overriding it.
6392@end deftypefn
6393
6394@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *name)
6395Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
6396the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6397may have added.
6398@end deftypefn
6399
6400@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (tree @var{exp})
6401Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
6402The default version of this hook always returns false.
6403@end deftypefn
6404
6405@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
6406Contains the value true if the target places read-only
6407``small data'' into a separate section.  The default value is false.
6408@end deftypevar
6409
6410@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (tree @var{exp})
6411Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
6412rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
6413or executable image).
6414
6415The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
6416for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
6417currently supported object file formats.
6418@end deftypefn
6419
6420@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
6421Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
6422The default value is false.
6423@end deftypevar
6424
6425
6426@node PIC
6427@section Position Independent Code
6428@cindex position independent code
6429@cindex PIC
6430
6431This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
6432independent code.  Simply defining these macros is not enough to
6433generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
6434@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
6435well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}.  You must modify the definition of
6436@samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
6437contains a symbolic address.  You may also need to alter the handling of
6438switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
6439@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
6440@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
6441
6442@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
6443The register number of the register used to address a table of static
6444data addresses in memory.  In some cases this register is defined by a
6445processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@.  When this macro
6446is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
6447pointer and frame pointer registers.  If this macro is not defined, it
6448is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
6449necessary).  Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
6450when @code{flag_pic} is true).
6451@end defmac
6452
6453@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
6454Define this macro if the register defined by
6455@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls.  Do not define
6456this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
6457@end defmac
6458
6459@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
6460A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
6461operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
6462You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
6463check this.  You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
6464check it either.  You need not define this macro if all constants
6465(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
6466position independent code.
6467@end defmac
6468
6469@node Assembler Format
6470@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
6471
6472This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
6473to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
6474instructions do.
6475
6476@menu
6477* File Framework::       Structural information for the assembler file.
6478* Data Output::          Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
6479* Uninitialized Data::   Output of uninitialized variables.
6480* Label Output::         Output and generation of labels.
6481* Initialization::       General principles of initialization
6482			   and termination routines.
6483* Macros for Initialization::
6484			 Specific macros that control the handling of
6485			   initialization and termination routines.
6486* Instruction Output::   Output of actual instructions.
6487* Dispatch Tables::      Output of jump tables.
6488* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
6489* Alignment Output::     Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
6490@end menu
6491
6492@node File Framework
6493@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
6494@cindex assembler format
6495@cindex output of assembler code
6496
6497@c prevent bad page break with this line
6498This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
6499
6500@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START ()
6501@findex default_file_start
6502Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
6503find at the beginning of a file.  The default behavior is controlled
6504by two flags, documented below.  Unless your target's assembler is
6505quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
6506@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook.  This
6507lets other target files rely on these variables.
6508@end deftypefn
6509
6510@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
6511If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
6512printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
6513@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect.  (If that macro has been defined
6514to the empty string, this variable has no effect.)  With the normal
6515definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
6516assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
6517whitespace from its input.  This allows it to work a bit faster.
6518
6519The default is false.  You should not set it to true unless you have
6520verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
6521comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
6522@end deftypevr
6523
6524@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
6525If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
6526for the primary source file, immediately after printing
6527@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled).  Most ELF assemblers expect
6528this to be done.  The default is false.
6529@end deftypevr
6530
6531@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END ()
6532Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
6533to find at the end of a file.  The default is to output nothing.
6534@end deftypefn
6535
6536@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
6537Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
6538special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
6539the stack being executable.  If your system uses this convention, you
6540should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function.  If you
6541need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
6542this function.
6543@end deftypefun
6544
6545@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
6546A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
6547assembler language.  The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
6548the end of the line.
6549@end defmac
6550
6551@defmac ASM_APP_ON
6552A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
6553statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
6554@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
6555assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
6556that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
6557@end defmac
6558
6559@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
6560A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
6561statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
6562@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
6563time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
6564@end defmac
6565
6566@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6567A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
6568which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
6569the stdio stream @var{stream}.
6570
6571This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
6572for the file format in use is appropriate.
6573@end defmac
6574
6575@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6576A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
6577@var{stream}.  If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
6578in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
6579the assembler source.  So you can use it to canonicalize the format
6580of the filename using this macro.
6581@end defmac
6582
6583@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6584A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
6585@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}.  If this
6586macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
6587@end defmac
6588
6589@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
6590Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}.  The section
6591should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
6592of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}.  If @var{align}
6593is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
6594otherwise some target default should be used.  Only targets that must
6595specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
6596@var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
6597@end deftypefn
6598
6599@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
6600This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
6601@end deftypefn
6602
6603@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
6604@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
6605This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
6606section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
6607This is true on most ELF targets.
6608@end deftypefn
6609
6610@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
6611Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
6612based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
6613declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations.  @var{decl} may be
6614 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
6615
6616The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
6617read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}.  You should only
6618need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
6619set via @code{__attribute__}.
6620@end deftypefn
6621
6622@need 2000
6623@node Data Output
6624@subsection Output of Data
6625
6626
6627@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
6628@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
6629@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
6630@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
6631@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
6632@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
6633@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
6634@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
6635@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
6636These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
6637of integer object.  The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
6638byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
6639aligned two-byte object, and so on.  Any of the hooks may be
6640@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
6641
6642The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
6643followed immediately by the object's initial value.  In most cases,
6644the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
6645@end deftypevr
6646
6647@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
6648The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
6649integer object.  @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
6650in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned.  The
6651function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
6652object.  If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
6653split the object into smaller parts.
6654
6655The default implementation of this hook will use the
6656@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
6657when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
6658@end deftypefn
6659
6660@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
6661A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
6662@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
6663@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}.  This may be used to
6664allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
6665
6666If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
6667@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed.  If it
6668prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
6669@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
6670@end defmac
6671
6672@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
6673A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6674instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
6675bytes at @var{ptr}.  @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
6676@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
6677
6678If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
6679Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
6680@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
6681@end defmac
6682
6683@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
6684A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
6685@var{decl}.  This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
6686is defined, and is otherwise unused.
6687@end defmac
6688
6689@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
6690You may define this macro as a C expression.  You should define the
6691expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
6692pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
6693GCC should output the constant pool after the function.  If you do
6694not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
6695pool before the function.
6696@end defmac
6697
6698@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
6699A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
6700constant pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving
6701the name of the function.  Should the return type of the function
6702be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size}
6703is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
6704immediately after this call.
6705
6706If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
6707not be defined.
6708@end defmac
6709
6710@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
6711A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
6712constant pool, if it needs special treatment.  (This macro need not do
6713anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
6714
6715The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
6716assembler code on.  @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
6717output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
6718@samp{const_int}).  @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
6719@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
6720alignment.
6721
6722The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
6723the address of this pool entry.  The definition of this macro is
6724responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
6725Here is how to do this:
6726
6727@smallexample
6728@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
6729@end smallexample
6730
6731When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
6732@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}.  This will prevent the same pool
6733entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
6734
6735You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
6736@end defmac
6737
6738@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
6739A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
6740pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
6741function.  Should the return type of the function be required, you can
6742obtain it via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
6743constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
6744
6745If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
6746define this macro.
6747@end defmac
6748
6749@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
6750Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
6751used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
6752
6753If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
6754the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
6755@end defmac
6756
6757@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
6758@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
6759These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
6760assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions.  If not overridden, they
6761default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
6762@end deftypevr
6763
6764  These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
6765of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
6766
6767@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6768@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6769@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6770@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
6771@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
6772@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
6773These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
6774target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
6775the variable @var{l}.  For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
6776@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
6777simple @code{long int}.  For the others, it should be an array of
6778@code{long int}.  The number of elements in this array is determined
6779by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
6780it go in each @code{long int} array element.  Each array element holds
678132 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
6782on the host machine.
6783
6784The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
6785using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
6786machine's memory.
6787@end defmac
6788
6789@node Uninitialized Data
6790@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
6791
6792Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
6793outputting a single uninitialized variable.
6794
6795@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6796A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6797@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
6798@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6799is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6800
6801Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6802output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6803assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6804
6805This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6806common global variables are output.
6807@end defmac
6808
6809@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6810Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
6811separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6812place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
6813handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6814as the number of bits.
6815@end defmac
6816
6817@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6818Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
6819variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6820is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6821in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
6822@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}.  Define this macro when you need to see
6823the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6824@end defmac
6825
6826@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6827A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6828@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
6829@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6830is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6831
6832Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6833defining this macro.  If unable, use the expression
6834@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6835before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6836the name, and a newline.
6837
6838There are two ways of handling global BSS.  One is to define either
6839this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
6840The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
6841switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
6842You do not need to do both.
6843
6844Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
6845non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
6846efficiently.  C++ is one example of this.  However, if the target does
6847not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
6848common in order to save space in the object file.
6849@end defmac
6850
6851@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6852Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6853separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6854place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6855handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6856as the number of bits.
6857
6858Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6859@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6860@end defmac
6861
6862@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6863A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6864@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6865@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6866is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6867
6868Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6869output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6870assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6871
6872This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6873static variables are output.
6874@end defmac
6875
6876@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6877Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6878separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6879place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6880handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6881as the number of bits.
6882@end defmac
6883
6884@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6885Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6886variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6887is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6888in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6889@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}.  Define this macro when you need to see
6890the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6891@end defmac
6892
6893@node Label Output
6894@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6895
6896@c prevent bad page break with this line
6897This is about outputting labels.
6898
6899@findex assemble_name
6900@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6901A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6902@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6903Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6904output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6905assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.  A default
6906definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
6907@end defmac
6908
6909@findex assemble_name_raw
6910@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6911Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
6912to refer to a compiler-generated label.  The default definition uses
6913@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
6914that it is more efficient.
6915@end defmac
6916
6917@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
6918A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6919size of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
6920default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
6921systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6922
6923Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
6924of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
6925for your system.  If you need your own custom definitions of those
6926macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
6927define this macro.
6928@end defmac
6929
6930@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
6931A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6932@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
6933symbol @var{name} is @var{size}.  @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
6934If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6935provided.
6936@end defmac
6937
6938@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6939A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6940@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
6941the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
6942address.
6943
6944If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6945provided.  The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
6946@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
6947the difference between this and another symbol.  If your assembler does
6948not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
6949to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
6950@end defmac
6951
6952@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
6953A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6954type of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
6955default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
6956systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6957
6958Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6959@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
6960custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6961types at all, do not define this macro.
6962@end defmac
6963
6964@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
6965A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
6966the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}.  On systems that use ELF, the
6967default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
6968the default is not to define this macro.
6969
6970Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6971@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
6972custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6973types at all, do not define this macro.
6974@end defmac
6975
6976@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
6977A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6978@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
6979symbol @var{name} is @var{type}.  @var{type} is a C string; currently,
6980that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
6981you should not count on this.
6982
6983If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
6984definition of this macro is provided.
6985@end defmac
6986
6987@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6988A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6989@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6990function which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
6991outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6992@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
6993@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6994
6995If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6996usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6997
6998You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
6999of this macro.
7000@end defmac
7001
7002@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7003A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7004@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7005which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7006function.  The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7007representing the function.
7008
7009If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7010
7011You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7012of this macro.
7013@end defmac
7014
7015@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7016A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7017@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7018initialized variable which is being defined.  This macro must output the
7019label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument
7020@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7021
7022If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7023usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7024
7025You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7026@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7027@end defmac
7028
7029@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{exp}, @var{size})
7030A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7031@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7032constant which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
7033outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7034@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument @var{exp} is the
7035value of the constant, and @var{size} is the size of the constant
7036in bytes.  @var{name} will be an internal label.
7037
7038If this macro is not defined, then the @var{name} is defined in the
7039usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7040
7041You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7042of this macro.
7043@end defmac
7044
7045@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7046A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7047@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7048for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7049
7050If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7051nothing.
7052@end defmac
7053
7054@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7055A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7056once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7057chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7058initializer.  This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7059something about the size of the object.
7060
7061If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7062nothing.
7063
7064You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7065@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7066@end defmac
7067
7068@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7069This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7070@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7071that is, available for reference from other files.
7072
7073The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7074@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7075@end deftypefn
7076
7077@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7078A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7079@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7080that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7081no other definition is available.  Use the expression
7082@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7083itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7084for making that name weak, and a newline.
7085
7086If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7087support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7088macro.
7089@end defmac
7090
7091@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7092Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7093@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7094or variable decl.  If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7095should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7096defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7097@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7098to make @var{name} weak.
7099@end defmac
7100
7101@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7102Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7103symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics.  @code{decl} is the
7104declaration of @code{name}.
7105@end defmac
7106
7107@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7108A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7109
7110If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7111definition.  If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7112is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
7113@samp{0}.  Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
7114with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
7115@end defmac
7116
7117@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7118A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7119public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7120be discarded by the linker.  Define this macro if your object file
7121format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7122section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7123requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7124@end defmac
7125
7126@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7127A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7128semantics.
7129
7130If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7131definition.  If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7132definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
7133you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7134setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7135be emitted as one-only.
7136@end defmac
7137
7138@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{visibility})
7139This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7140commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7141hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7142@end deftypefn
7143
7144@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7145A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7146that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7147The default is @code{0}.
7148
7149Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7150if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7151will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7152symbol should not be weak.  Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7153thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7154(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7155with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7156
7157The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero.  Define this macro for
7158targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7159restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7160table of contents.
7161@end defmac
7162
7163@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7164A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7165@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7166symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7167not defined.  The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7168declaration.
7169
7170This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7171The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7172@end defmac
7173
7174@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
7175This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7176pseudo-op to declare a library function name external.  The name of the
7177library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7178@end deftypefn
7179
7180@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (tree @var{decl})
7181This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7182directive to annotate used symbol.  Darwin target use .no_dead_code_strip
7183directive.
7184@end deftypefn
7185
7186@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7187A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7188@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7189@var{name}.  This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7190is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7191systems.  This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7192@end defmac
7193
7194@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7195A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7196@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}.  If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7197will be used to output the name of the symbol.  This macro may be used
7198to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7199encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7200@end defmac
7201
7202@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7203A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7204result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.  If not defined,
7205@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7206This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7207specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7208when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7209being taken.
7210@end defmac
7211
7212@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
7213A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7214name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
7215
7216It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
7217used for user-level functions and variables.  Otherwise, certain programs
7218will have name conflicts with internal labels.
7219
7220It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
7221object file.  Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
7222should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
7223beginning of a label has this effect.  You should find out what
7224convention your system uses, and follow it.
7225
7226The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
7227@end deftypefn
7228
7229@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
7230A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
7231label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
7232@var{num}.  This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
7233may need to be treated differently than branch target labels.  On some
7234systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
7235bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
7236bundles.
7237
7238If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
7239used.
7240@end defmac
7241
7242@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
7243A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
7244is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
7245
7246This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
7247produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
7248with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
7249
7250If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
7251output the rest of the string unchanged.  It is often convenient for
7252@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way.  If the
7253string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
7254to output the string, and may change it.  (Of course,
7255@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
7256you should know what it does on your machine.)
7257@end defmac
7258
7259@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
7260A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
7261@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
7262@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
7263added.  Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
7264
7265The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
7266produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
7267@var{name}.  Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
7268assembler code.  The argument @var{number} is different each time this
7269macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
7270internal static variables in different scopes.
7271
7272Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
7273conflict with the user's own symbols.  Most assemblers allow periods
7274or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
7275between the name and the number will suffice.
7276
7277If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
7278which is correct for most systems.
7279@end defmac
7280
7281@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7282A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
7283which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
7284
7285@findex SET_ASM_OP
7286If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
7287correct for most systems.
7288@end defmac
7289
7290@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
7291A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
7292which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
7293to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}.  This macro will
7294be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
7295the tree nodes are available.
7296
7297@findex SET_ASM_OP
7298If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
7299correct for most systems.
7300@end defmac
7301
7302@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
7303A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
7304(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
7305of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
7306current compilation unit.  The default is to not defer output of defines.
7307This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
7308@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
7309@end defmac
7310
7311@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7312A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
7313which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7314@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
7315an undefined weak symbol.
7316
7317Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
7318@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
7319@end defmac
7320
7321@node Initialization
7322@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
7323@cindex initialization routines
7324@cindex termination routines
7325@cindex constructors, output of
7326@cindex destructors, output of
7327
7328The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
7329(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
7330data in the program when the program is started.  These functions need
7331to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
7332@code{main} is called.
7333
7334Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
7335@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
7336terminates.
7337
7338To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
7339must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
7340be called at the appropriate time.  When you port the compiler to a new
7341system, you need to specify how to do this.
7342
7343There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
7344initialization and termination functions.  Each way has two variants.
7345Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
7346
7347@findex __CTOR_LIST__
7348@findex __DTOR_LIST__
7349The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
7350initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
7351termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
7352
7353Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
73540, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
7355the environment).  This is followed by a series of zero or more function
7356pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
7357pointer containing zero.
7358
7359Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
7360@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
7361time and exit time.  Constructors are called in reverse order of the
7362list; destructors in forward order.
7363
7364The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
7365formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections.  A section is set
7366aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
7367Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}.  Each
7368object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
7369the constructor section to point to that function.  The linker
7370accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
7371Termination functions are handled similarly.
7372
7373This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
7374@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined.  A target that does not
7375support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
7376constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7377and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
7378
7379When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
7380upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called.  On systems that
7381support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
7382parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section.  The
7383program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
7384
7385@smallexample
7386ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
7387@end smallexample
7388
7389The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
7390section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}.  Likewise
7391for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section.  Normally these
7392files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
7393are provided by GCC for a few targets.
7394
7395The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
7396compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}.  They contain, among other things, code
7397fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
7398to routines in the @code{.text} section.  The linker will pull all parts
7399of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
7400that invokes the routines we need at startup.
7401
7402To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7403macro properly.
7404
7405If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
7406@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
7407entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
7408it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
7409after the function prologue.  The @code{__main} function is defined
7410in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
7411
7412In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
7413two variants.  In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
7414and an `a.out' format must be used.  In this case,
7415@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
7416entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
7417and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
7418code as its value.  The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
7419the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
7420placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
7421a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
7422@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly.  Since no init
7423section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
7424the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
7425the initialization process.
7426
7427The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
7428This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
7429file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@.  In
7430this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
7431termination functions are recognized simply by their names.  This requires
7432an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}.  This program
7433pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
7434the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
7435initialization and termination functions.  These functions are called
7436via @code{__main} as described above.  In order to use this method,
7437@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
7438
7439@ifinfo
7440The following section describes the specific macros that control and
7441customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
7442@end ifinfo
7443
7444@node Macros for Initialization
7445@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
7446
7447Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
7448and termination functions:
7449
7450@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7451If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
7452operation to identify the following data as initialization code.  If not
7453defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  When you are
7454using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
7455macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
7456run the initialization functions.
7457@end defmac
7458
7459@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
7460If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
7461This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
7462on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
7463be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7464@end defmac
7465
7466@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
7467If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7468the following symbol is an initialization routine.
7469@end defmac
7470
7471@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
7472If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7473the following symbol is a finalization routine.
7474@end defmac
7475
7476@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7477If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7478automatically called when a shared library is loaded.  The function
7479should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
7480the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
7481function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
7482
7483This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
7484shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
7485exception tables embedded in the code.
7486@end defmac
7487
7488@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7489If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7490automatically called when a shared library is unloaded.  The function
7491should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
7492the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
7493function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
7494@end defmac
7495
7496@defmac INVOKE__main
7497If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
7498@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  This macro should be defined for systems
7499where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
7500useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
7501@end defmac
7502
7503@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
7504If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
7505compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
7506of objects.  If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
7507encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
7508@end defmac
7509
7510@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
7511This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
7512collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
7513It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
7514@end deftypefn
7515
7516@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7517If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
7518the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
7519
7520Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
7521no arguments and with no return value.  If the target supports initialization
7522priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
7523otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
7524
7525If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
7526be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
7527target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
7528is not defined.
7529@end deftypefn
7530
7531@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7532This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
7533functions rather than initialization functions.
7534@end deftypefn
7535
7536If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
7537generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
7538
7539If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
7540constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
7541an object file for constructor functions to be called.
7542
7543On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
7544@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
7545
7546@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
7547Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
7548object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
7549object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
7550
7551This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
7552part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
7553@end defmac
7554
7555@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
7556Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
7557to execute @command{nm}.  The default is to search the path normally for
7558@command{nm}.
7559
7560If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
7561dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
7562these macros to enable support for running initialization and
7563termination functions in shared libraries:
7564@end defmac
7565
7566@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
7567Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
7568which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
7569@end defmac
7570
7571@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
7572Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
7573of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  @var{ptr} is a variable
7574of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
7575from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
7576code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
7577line.  Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
7578@end defmac
7579
7580@node Instruction Output
7581@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
7582
7583@c prevent bad page break with this line
7584This describes assembler instruction output.
7585
7586@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
7587A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
7588registers, each one as a C string constant.  This is what translates
7589register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
7590@end defmac
7591
7592@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
7593If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
7594and a register number.  This macro defines additional names for hard
7595registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
7596to registers using alternate names.
7597@end defmac
7598
7599@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
7600Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
7601requires different names for the machine instructions.
7602
7603The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
7604assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}.  The
7605macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
7606points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
7607written in the machine description.  The definition should output the
7608opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
7609increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
7610so that it will not be output twice.
7611
7612In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
7613name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
7614that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
7615care of the substitution yourself.  Just be sure to increment
7616@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
7617
7618@findex recog_data.operand
7619If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
7620elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
7621
7622If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
7623in the usual way.
7624@end defmac
7625
7626@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
7627If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
7628assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
7629they will be output differently.
7630
7631Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
7632extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
7633elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
7634The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
7635template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
7636by changing the contents of the vector.
7637
7638This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
7639file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
7640can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
7641as with rearranged operands).  Naturally, variations in assembler
7642syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
7643writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
7644
7645If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
7646@end defmac
7647
7648@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
7649A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7650assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}.  @var{x} is an
7651RTL expression.
7652
7653@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
7654of printing the operand.  It is used when identical operands must be
7655printed differently depending on the context.  @var{code} comes from
7656the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
7657operand.  If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
7658@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
7659@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
7660
7661@findex reg_names
7662If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
7663The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
7664@code{char *[]}.  @code{reg_names} is initialized from
7665@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
7666
7667When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
7668(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
7669with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
7670@var{code}.
7671@end defmac
7672
7673@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
7674A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
7675punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro.  If
7676@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
7677punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
7678in this way.
7679@end defmac
7680
7681@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
7682A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7683assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
7684whose address is @var{x}.  @var{x} is an RTL expression.
7685
7686@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
7687On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
7688section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the hook
7689@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
7690@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  @xref{Assembler
7691Format}.
7692@end defmac
7693
7694@findex dbr_sequence_length
7695@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
7696A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
7697been output.  If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
7698determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
7699currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
7700or whatever.
7701
7702Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
7703reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
7704explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
7705@end defmac
7706
7707@findex final_sequence
7708Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
7709prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
7710(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
7711found.)  The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
7712processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
7713being output.
7714
7715@findex asm_fprintf
7716@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
7717@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
7718@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
7719@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
7720If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
7721@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
7722@file{final.c}).  These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
7723support multiple assembler formats.  In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
7724files can define these macros differently.
7725@end defmac
7726
7727@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
7728If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
7729statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
7730the @code{asm_fprintf} function.  This allows targets to define extra
7731printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
7732statements.  Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
7733generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
7734specific code.  The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
7735The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
7736string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
7737upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
7738@end defmac
7739
7740@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
7741If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
7742different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
7743numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
7744first variant.
7745
7746If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
7747@smallexample
7748@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
7749@end smallexample
7750@noindent
7751in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
7752first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}.  This construct outputs
7753@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
7754@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc.  Any special characters
7755within these strings retain their usual meaning.  If there are fewer
7756alternatives within the braces than the value of
7757@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
7758
7759If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
7760@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
7761operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
7762
7763Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
7764@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
7765the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism.  Define
7766@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
7767if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
7768opcodes or operand order.
7769@end defmac
7770
7771@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7772A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7773which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
7774The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7775profiling.
7776@end defmac
7777
7778@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7779A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7780which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
7781The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7782profiling.
7783@end defmac
7784
7785@node Dispatch Tables
7786@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
7787
7788@c prevent bad page break with this line
7789This concerns dispatch tables.
7790
7791@cindex dispatch table
7792@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
7793A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7794pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
7795@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels.  The
7796definitions of these labels are output using
7797@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
7798way here.  For example,
7799
7800@smallexample
7801fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
7802         @var{value}, @var{rel})
7803@end smallexample
7804
7805You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
7806dispatch table are relative to the table's own address.  If defined, GCC
7807will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
7808@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
7809mode and flags can be read.
7810@end defmac
7811
7812@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
7813This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
7814in a dispatch table are absolute.
7815
7816The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
7817@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
7818a label.  @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
7819definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7820For example,
7821
7822@smallexample
7823fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
7824@end smallexample
7825@end defmac
7826
7827@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7828Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
7829specially.  The first three arguments are the same as for
7830@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
7831jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
7832@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
7833
7834This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
7835for the table.
7836
7837If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
7838@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7839@end defmac
7840
7841@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7842Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
7843jump-table.  The definition should be a C statement to be executed
7844after the assembler code for the table is written.  It should write
7845the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}.  The argument
7846@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
7847of the preceding label.
7848
7849If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
7850the jump-table.
7851@end defmac
7852
7853@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{for_eh}, @var{empty})
7854This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@.  It
7855should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
7856should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
7857function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7858The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
7859exception table.  The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
7860true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
7861
7862The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
7863@end deftypefn
7864
7865@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (@var{stream})
7866This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
7867It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
7868to be broken up according to function.
7869
7870The default is that no label is emitted.
7871@end deftypefn
7872
7873@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE * @var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
7874This target hook emits and assembly directives required to unwind the
7875given instruction.  This is only used when TARGET_UNWIND_INFO is set.
7876@end deftypefn
7877
7878@node Exception Region Output
7879@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
7880
7881@c prevent bad page break with this line
7882
7883This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
7884region.
7885
7886@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7887If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
7888exception handling frame unwind information.  If not defined, GCC will
7889provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7890@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
7891
7892You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
7893unwind information and the default definition does not work.
7894@end defmac
7895
7896@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7897If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
7898data section even though the target supports named sections.  This
7899might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
7900collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
7901
7902Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
7903also defined.
7904@end defmac
7905
7906@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
7907Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
7908information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
7909runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
7910and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
7911@end defmac
7912
7913@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7914An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
7915that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
7916@end defmac
7917
7918@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7919Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
7920information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
7921Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
7922@samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
7923or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
7924
7925If @code{TARGET_UNWIND_INFO} is defined, the target specific unwinder
7926will be used in all cases.  Defining this macro will enable the generation
7927of DWARF 2 frame debugging information.
7928
7929If @code{TARGET_UNWIND_INFO} is not defined, and this macro is defined to 1,
7930the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default exception handling mechanism;
7931otherwise, the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme will be used by
7932default.
7933@end defmac
7934
7935@defmac TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
7936Define this macro if your target has ABI specified unwind tables.  Usually
7937these will be output by @code{TARGET_UNWIND_EMIT}.
7938@end defmac
7939
7940@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
7941This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
7942tables even when exceptions are not used.
7943@end deftypevar
7944
7945@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
7946This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
7947runtime-variable.  In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
7948determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
7949so the target must provide it directly.
7950@end defmac
7951
7952@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
7953Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
7954should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
7955instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
7956@end defmac
7957
7958@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7959This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7960function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7961@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  The definition should be the negative minimum
7962alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7963minimum alignment otherwise.  @xref{SDB and DWARF}.  Only applicable if
7964the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7965@end defmac
7966
7967@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7968Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
7969end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
7970Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
7971true otherwise.
7972@end deftypevar
7973
7974@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
7975Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
7976represent where to find the register pieces.  Define this hook if the
7977register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
7978locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
7979register in Dwarf.  Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
7980If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
7981@end deftypefn
7982
7983@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
7984This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
7985the type_info object identified by @var{sym}.  It should return @code{true}
7986if the reference was output.  Returning @code{false} will cause the
7987reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
7988@end deftypefn
7989
7990@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
7991This hook should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
7992based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets.  This effects
7993the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
7994running a cleanup.  The default is @code{false}.
7995@end deftypefn
7996
7997@node Alignment Output
7998@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7999
8000@c prevent bad page break with this line
8001This describes commands for alignment.
8002
8003@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8004The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8005a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8006
8007This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8008to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
8009define the macro.
8010
8011Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8012to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8013@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8014selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8015@end defmac
8016
8017@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8018The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8019a @code{BARRIER}.
8020
8021This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8022to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
8023define the macro.
8024@end defmac
8025
8026@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8027The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
8028@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}.  This works only if
8029@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8030@end defmac
8031
8032@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8033The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8034a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8035
8036This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8037to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
8038define the macro.
8039
8040Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8041to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8042@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8043selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8044@end defmac
8045
8046@defmac LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8047The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
8048This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8049@end defmac
8050
8051@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8052The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8053If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8054the maximum of the specified values is used.
8055
8056Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8057to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8058@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8059selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8060@end defmac
8061
8062@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8063The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
8064This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8065@end defmac
8066
8067@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8068A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8069instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8070Those bytes should be zero when loaded.  @var{nbytes} will be a C
8071expression of type @code{int}.
8072@end defmac
8073
8074@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8075Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8076text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8077This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8078produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8079section.
8080@end defmac
8081
8082@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8083A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8084command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8085@var{power} bytes.  @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8086@end defmac
8087
8088@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8089Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8090for padding, if necessary.
8091@end defmac
8092
8093@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8094A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8095command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8096@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8097satisfy the alignment request.  @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8098a C expression of type @code{int}.
8099@end defmac
8100
8101@need 3000
8102@node Debugging Info
8103@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8104
8105@c prevent bad page break with this line
8106This describes how to specify debugging information.
8107
8108@menu
8109* All Debuggers::      Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
8110* DBX Options::        Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
8111* DBX Hooks::          Hook macros for varying DBX format.
8112* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
8113* SDB and DWARF::      Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
8114* VMS Debug::          Macros for VMS debug format.
8115@end menu
8116
8117@node All Debuggers
8118@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
8119
8120@c prevent bad page break with this line
8121These macros affect all debugging formats.
8122
8123@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
8124A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
8125register number @var{regno}.  In the default macro provided, the value
8126of this expression will be @var{regno} itself.  But sometimes there are
8127some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
8128versa.  In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
8129compiler and another for DBX@.
8130
8131If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
8132used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
8133consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
8134Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
8135expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
8136
8137If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
8138does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
8139redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
8140@end defmac
8141
8142@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
8143A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
8144variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The default
8145computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
8146gives the offset from the frame-pointer.  This is required for targets
8147that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
8148for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
8149@option{-g} options is used.
8150@end defmac
8151
8152@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
8153A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
8154having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The nominal offset is
8155@var{offset}.
8156@end defmac
8157
8158@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
8159A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
8160produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}.  Define
8161this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
8162debugging output.  Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
8163@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
8164@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
8165
8166When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
8167value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
8168exceptions.  If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
8169value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}.  Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
8170defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
8171
8172The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
8173user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
8174@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
8175@end defmac
8176
8177@node DBX Options
8178@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
8179
8180@c prevent bad page break with this line
8181These are specific options for DBX output.
8182
8183@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
8184Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
8185in response to the @option{-g} option.
8186@end defmac
8187
8188@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
8189Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
8190in response to the @option{-g} option.  This is a variant of DBX format.
8191@end defmac
8192
8193@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
8194Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
8195GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
8196debugging information is enabled at all).  If you don't define the
8197macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
8198if there is any occasion to.
8199@end defmac
8200
8201@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
8202Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
8203in the text section.
8204@end defmac
8205
8206@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
8207A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
8208use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
8209If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used.  This macro
8210applies only to DBX debugging information format.
8211@end defmac
8212
8213@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
8214A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
8215use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
8216value is the current location.  If you don't define this macro,
8217@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used.  This macro applies only to DBX debugging
8218information format.
8219@end defmac
8220
8221@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
8222A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
8223use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
8224name.  If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used.  This
8225macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
8226@end defmac
8227
8228@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
8229Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
8230@samp{xs@var{tagname}}.  On some systems, this construct is used to
8231describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
8232On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
8233@end defmac
8234
8235@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
8236A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
8237continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
8238exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters).  On some
8239operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
8240must not be done.  You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
8241with the value zero.  You can override the default splitting-length by
8242defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
8243@end defmac
8244
8245@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
8246Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
8247the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows.  To use
8248a different character instead, define this macro as a character
8249constant for the character you want to use.  Do not define this macro
8250if backslash is correct for your system.
8251@end defmac
8252
8253@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
8254Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
8255outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
8256variable.
8257@end defmac
8258
8259@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
8260The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
8261for a typedef.  The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
8262@end defmac
8263
8264@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
8265The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
8266for a static variable located in the text section.  DBX format does not
8267provide any ``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_FUN}.
8268@end defmac
8269
8270@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
8271The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
8272for a parameter passed in registers.  DBX format does not provide any
8273``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
8274@end defmac
8275
8276@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
8277The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
8278passed in registers.  DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
8279do this.  The default is @code{'P'}.
8280@end defmac
8281
8282@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
8283Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
8284arguments should precede the assembler code for the function.  Normally,
8285in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
8286code.
8287@end defmac
8288
8289@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
8290Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
8291the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
8292relative to the start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses
8293an absolute address.
8294@end defmac
8295
8296@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
8297Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
8298the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
8299start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
8300@end defmac
8301
8302@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
8303Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
8304@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems.  This
8305macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
8306number and a type number within the file.  Normally, GCC does not
8307generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
8308number for a type number.
8309@end defmac
8310
8311@node DBX Hooks
8312@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
8313
8314@c prevent bad page break with this line
8315These are hooks for DBX format.
8316
8317@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8318Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
8319information for the start of a scope level for variable names.  The
8320argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
8321@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
8322@end defmac
8323
8324@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8325Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
8326@end defmac
8327
8328@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
8329Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
8330output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
8331@end defmac
8332
8333@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
8334A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
8335number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
8336@var{stream}.  @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
8337invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
8338unique labels in the assembly output.
8339
8340This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
8341if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
8342@end defmac
8343
8344@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
8345Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
8346@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
8347On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
8348disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
8349@end defmac
8350
8351@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
8352Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
8353extension construct.  On those machines, define this macro to turn this
8354feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
8355@end defmac
8356
8357@node File Names and DBX
8358@subsection File Names in DBX Format
8359
8360@c prevent bad page break with this line
8361This describes file names in DBX format.
8362
8363@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8364A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8365@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
8366file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
8367This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
8368
8369This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8370for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8371
8372It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
8373text section.  You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
8374to do so.  If you do this, you must also set the variable
8375@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
8376@end defmac
8377
8378@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
8379Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
8380of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
8381the beginning of the file.
8382@end defmac
8383
8384@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
8385Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
8386that this object file was compiled by GCC@.  The default is to emit
8387an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
8388@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
8389@end defmac
8390
8391@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8392A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
8393compilation of the main source file @var{name}.  Output should be
8394written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8395
8396If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
8397of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
8398@end defmac
8399
8400@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
8401Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
8402@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
8403the end of compilation is a @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
8404whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
8405@end defmac
8406
8407@need 2000
8408@node SDB and DWARF
8409@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
8410
8411@c prevent bad page break with this line
8412Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
8413
8414@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
8415Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
8416for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
8417@end defmac
8418
8419@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
8420Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
8421debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
8422
8423@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (tree @var{function})
8424Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
8425be emitted for each function.  Instead of an integer return the enum
8426value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
8427@end deftypefn
8428
8429To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
8430define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
8431@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
8432prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
8433as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
8434@end defmac
8435
8436@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
8437Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
8438Dwarf 2 frame information.  If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
8439(@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
8440information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
8441@end defmac
8442
8443@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
8444Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
8445line debug info sections.  This will result in much more compact line number
8446tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
8447@end defmac
8448
8449@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
8450A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
8451@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
8452@end defmac
8453
8454@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
8455A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
8456section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
8457given @var{size}.  The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
8458@end defmac
8459
8460@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
8461A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
8462reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
8463@end defmac
8464
8465@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{FILE}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
8466If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
8467reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
8468@end deftypefn
8469
8470@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
8471Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
8472SDB assembler directives.  See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
8473macros and their arguments.  If the standard syntax is used, you need
8474not define them yourself.
8475@end defmac
8476
8477@defmac SDB_DELIM
8478Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
8479SDB assembler directives.  In that case, define this macro to be the
8480delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}).  It is not necessary to define
8481a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
8482required.
8483@end defmac
8484
8485@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
8486Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
8487union, or enumeration tags to be emitted.  Standard COFF does not
8488allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
8489it.
8490@end defmac
8491
8492@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
8493Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
8494enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled.  Some
8495assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
8496@end defmac
8497
8498@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
8499A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
8500number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
8501@var{stream}.  The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
8502@end defmac
8503
8504@need 2000
8505@node VMS Debug
8506@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
8507
8508@c prevent bad page break with this line
8509Here are macros for VMS debug format.
8510
8511@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8512Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
8513in response to the @option{-g} option.  The default behavior for VMS
8514is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
8515@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}.  This
8516behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
8517@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
8518@end defmac
8519
8520@node Floating Point
8521@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
8522@cindex cross compilation and floating point
8523@cindex floating point and cross compilation
8524
8525While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
8526there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers.  This
8527means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
8528in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
8529doing the compilation.
8530
8531Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
8532range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
8533the target machine's format.  Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
8534safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
8535the target's arithmetic.  To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
8536emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
8537target floating point formats are identical.
8538
8539The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
8540use.  All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
8541floating-point calculations must use these macros.  They may evaluate
8542their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
8543
8544@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
8545The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
8546machine's format.  Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
8547array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
8548quantity.
8549@end defmac
8550
8551@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8552Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}.  If the target
8553floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
8554@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
8555@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
8556@end deftypefn
8557
8558@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8559Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
8560@end deftypefn
8561
8562@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8563Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
8564@end deftypefn
8565
8566@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8567Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero.  If
8568@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
8569@end deftypefn
8570
8571@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8572Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
8573representation for mode @var{mode}.  This routine can handle both
8574decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
8575defined by the C language for both.
8576@end deftypefn
8577
8578@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8579Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
8580@end deftypefn
8581
8582@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8583Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
8584@end deftypefn
8585
8586@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8587Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
8588@end deftypefn
8589
8590@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8591Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
8592@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
8593variable).
8594
8595The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}.  Only the
8596following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
8597@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
8598
8599If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
8600target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
8601@code{abort}.  Callers should check for this situation first, using
8602@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}.  @xref{Storage Layout}.
8603@end deftypefn
8604
8605@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8606Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
8607@end deftypefn
8608
8609@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8610Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
8611@end deftypefn
8612
8613@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
8614Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}.  The
8615return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
8616appropriate bit pattern to be output asa floating constant whose
8617precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
8618@end deftypefn
8619
8620@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8621Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
8622which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}.  If the value is not
8623integral, it is truncated.
8624@end deftypefn
8625
8626@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8627Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
8628into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.  The
8629value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
8630@end deftypefn
8631
8632@node Mode Switching
8633@section Mode Switching Instructions
8634@cindex mode switching
8635The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
8636
8637@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
8638Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
8639switching in an optimizing compilation.
8640
8641For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
8642floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
8643the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
8644operation, this bit has to be set.  Changing the PR bit requires a general
8645purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
8646be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
8647or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
8648
8649You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
8650which entities actually need it.  @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
8651return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
8652If you define this macro, you also have to define
8653@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
8654@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
8655@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
8656are optional.
8657@end defmac
8658
8659@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
8660If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
8661initializer for an array of integers.  Each initializer element
8662N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
8663of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
8664The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
8665zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
8666entity in question.
8667In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
8668represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1.  N is used to specify that no mode
8669switch is needed / supplied.
8670@end defmac
8671
8672@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
8673@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If
8674@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
8675return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
8676@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
8677be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
8678@end defmac
8679
8680@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
8681If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
8682mode switching.  It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
8683different from the incoming mode).
8684@end defmac
8685
8686@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
8687If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8688mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
8689@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry.  If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
8690is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
8691@end defmac
8692
8693@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
8694If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8695mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
8696@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit.  If @code{MODE_EXIT}
8697is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
8698@end defmac
8699
8700@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
8701This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
87020 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
8703lowest.  The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
8704for @var{entity}.  For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
8705(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
8706@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
8707@end defmac
8708
8709@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
8710Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
8711@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
8712the insn(s) are to be inserted.
8713@end defmac
8714
8715@node Target Attributes
8716@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
8717@cindex target attributes
8718@cindex machine attributes
8719@cindex attributes, target-specific
8720
8721Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
8722These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
8723be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
8724
8725@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
8726If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
8727attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
8728specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
8729entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
8730take.
8731@end deftypevr
8732
8733@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8734If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
8735@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
8736and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
8737generated).  If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
8738supposed always to be compatible.
8739@end deftypefn
8740
8741@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
8742If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
8743newly defined @var{type}.
8744@end deftypefn
8745
8746@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8747Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
8748handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8749@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}.  It is assumed
8750that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1.  This
8751function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
8752merging.
8753@end deftypefn
8754
8755@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
8756Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
8757handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8758@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
8759@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}.  Examples of
8760when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
8761attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition.  This function may
8762call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
8763
8764@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
8765If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
8766for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
8767@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}.  The compiler
8768will then define a function called
8769@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
8770the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  You can also
8771add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
8772to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
8773@samp{dllexport} attributes.  This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
8774@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
8775@end deftypefn
8776
8777@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{decl})
8778@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))}
8779specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation
8780checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
8781@end deftypefn
8782
8783@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
8784Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
8785@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}.  By
8786default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
8787@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  The current implementation
8788of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
8789on this implementation detail.
8790@end defmac
8791
8792@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
8793Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
8794when it is being created.  This is normally useful for back ends which
8795wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
8796the pragma's effect.  The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
8797created.  The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
8798for this decl.  The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
8799shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
8800the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
8801attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
8802needed.
8803@end deftypefn
8804
8805@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
8806@cindex inlining
8807This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
8808into the current function, despite its having target-specific
8809attributes, @code{false} otherwise.  By default, if a function has a
8810target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
8811@end deftypefn
8812
8813@node MIPS Coprocessors
8814@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
8815@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
8816
8817The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
8818coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers.  GCC supports
8819accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
8820and memory using asm-ized variables.  For example:
8821
8822@smallexample
8823  register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
8824  unsigned int d;
8825
8826  d = cp0count + 3;
8827@end smallexample
8828
8829(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
8830names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
8831overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
8832
8833Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
8834be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
8835later in the function.
8836
8837Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8838the FPU@.  One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
8839floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
8840
8841There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
8842you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
8843
8844@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8845A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
8846alternate names of coprocessor registers.  The format of each entry should be
8847@smallexample
8848@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
8849@end smallexample
8850Default: empty.
8851@end defmac
8852
8853@node PCH Target
8854@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
8855@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
8856
8857@deftypefn {Target Hook} void *TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
8858This hook returns the data needed by @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
8859@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
8860@end deftypefn
8861
8862@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
8863This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
8864compatible with the current settings.  It returns @code{NULL}
8865if so and a suitable error message if not.  Error messages will
8866be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
8867
8868@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
8869when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
8870It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
8871compiler, so no format checking is needed.
8872
8873The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
8874suitable for most targets.
8875@end deftypefn
8876
8877@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
8878If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
8879@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
8880of @code{target_flags}.  @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
8881@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created.  The return
8882value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
8883@end deftypefn
8884
8885@node C++ ABI
8886@section C++ ABI parameters
8887@cindex parameters, c++ abi
8888
8889@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
8890Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
8891These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects.  The
8892default is long_long_integer_type_node.
8893@end deftypefn
8894
8895@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
8896This hook determines how guard variables are used.  It should return
8897@code{false} (the default) if first byte should be used.  A return value of
8898@code{true} indicates the least significant bit should be used.
8899@end deftypefn
8900
8901@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
8902This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
8903whose elements have the indicated @var{type}.  Assumes that it is already
8904known that a cookie is needed.  The default is
8905@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
8906IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
8907@end deftypefn
8908
8909@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
8910This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
8911array cookies.  The default is to return @code{false}.
8912@end deftypefn
8913
8914@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree  @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
8915If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
8916class @var{type} to be overruled.  Upon entry @var{import_export}
8917will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
8918to be imported and 0 otherwise.  This function should return the
8919modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
8920backend's targeted operating system.
8921@end deftypefn
8922
8923@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
8924This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
8925the address of the object created/destroyed.  The default is to return
8926@code{false}.
8927@end deftypefn
8928
8929@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
8930This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
8931which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
8932table to be emitted) may be an inline function.  Under the standard
8933Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
8934the function is not declared inline in the class definition.  Under
8935some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
8936method.  The default is to return @code{true}.
8937@end deftypefn
8938
8939@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
8940@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object,
8941or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with
8942external linkage in this translation unit.  No ELF visibility has been
8943explicitly specified.  If the target needs to specify a visibility
8944other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set
8945@code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
8946@end deftypefn
8947
8948@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
8949This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
8950similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
8951external linkage.  If this hook returns false, then class data for
8952classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
8953unit will not be COMDAT.
8954@end deftypefn
8955
8956@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
8957This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
8958the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
8959be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
8960@end deftypefn
8961
8962@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
8963This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
8964should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
8965is in effect.  The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
8966@end deftypefn
8967
8968@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
8969@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been
8970defined.  Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak
8971visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
8972@end deftypefn
8973
8974@node Misc
8975@section Miscellaneous Parameters
8976@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
8977
8978@c prevent bad page break with this line
8979Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
8980
8981@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
8982Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
8983has conditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
8984conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
8985blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
8986set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
8987to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
8988@end defmac
8989
8990@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
8991Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
8992has unconditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
8993conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
8994blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
8995set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
8996to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
8997@end defmac
8998
8999@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
9000An alias for a machine mode name.  This is the machine mode that
9001elements of a jump-table should have.
9002@end defmac
9003
9004@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
9005Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
9006when the minimum and maximum offset are known.  If you define this,
9007it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
9008To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
9009make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
9010The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
9011flags can be updated.
9012@end defmac
9013
9014@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
9015Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
9016should contain relative addresses.  You need not define this macro if
9017jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
9018contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
9019is in effect.
9020@end defmac
9021
9022@defmac CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
9023Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
9024is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
9025The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
9026five otherwise.  This is best for most machines.
9027@end defmac
9028
9029@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
9030Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
9031statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests.  This is
9032advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
9033of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
9034targets that would require a loop.  By default, this macro returns
9035@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
9036@code{false} otherwise.
9037@end defmac
9038
9039@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
9040Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
9041smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
9042Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
9043@end defmac
9044
9045@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
9046Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
9047memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
9048bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
9049zero-extension of the data read.  Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
9050of @var{mem_mode} for which the
9051insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
9052@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
9053
9054This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
9055greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
9056value in this case.  Do not define this macro if it would always return
9057@code{UNKNOWN}.  On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
9058define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
9059
9060You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
9061the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
9062of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
9063when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
9064integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
9065
9066You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
9067mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
9068@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
9069is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
9070@end defmac
9071
9072@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
9073Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
9074extends.
9075@end defmac
9076
9077@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
9078Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
9079point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
9080unsigned one.
9081@end defmac
9082
9083@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9084When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
9085divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
9086the reciprocal.  This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
9087that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
9088of mode @var{mode}.  The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
9089has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
9090@end deftypefn
9091
9092@defmac MOVE_MAX
9093The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
9094between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
9095@end defmac
9096
9097@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
9098The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
9099between memory and registers or between two memory locations.  If this
9100is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}.  Otherwise, it is the
9101constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
9102at run-time.
9103@end defmac
9104
9105@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
9106A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
9107actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
9108of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted.  When
9109this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
9110a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
9111truncates the count of a shift operation.  On machines that have
9112instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
9113include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
9114also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
9115arguments to bit-field instructions.
9116
9117If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
9118position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
9119instructions exist, you should define this macro.
9120
9121However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
9122only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
9123bit-field operations.  Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
9124such machines.  Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
9125the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
9126
9127You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
9128@end defmac
9129
9130@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
9131@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9132This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
9133deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
9134@xref{shift patterns}.
9135
9136On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
9137shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
9138equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}.  If
9139this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
9140otherwise it should return 0.  A return value of 0 indicates that no
9141particular behavior is guaranteed.
9142
9143Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
9144@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
9145that are generated by the named shift patterns.
9146
9147The default implementation of this function returns
9148@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
9149and 0 otherwise.  This definition is always safe, but if
9150@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
9151nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
9152by overriding it.
9153@end deftypefn
9154
9155@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
9156A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
9157``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
9158bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
9159operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
9160
9161On many machines, this expression can be 1.
9162
9163@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that".  this was
9164@c to fix an overfull hbox.  --mew 10feb93
9165When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
9166modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
9167If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
9168such cases may improve things.
9169@end defmac
9170
9171@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
9172The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
9173are always extended to a wider integral mode.  Return
9174@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
9175sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}.  Return @code{UNKNOWN}
9176otherwise.  (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
9177representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
9178@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
9179@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}.  Also no target extends
9180@var{mode} to @var{mode_rep} so that @var{mode_rep} is not the next
9181widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
9182
9183Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
9184value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
9185as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
9186@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
9187
9188Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
9189describe two related properties.  If you define
9190@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
9191to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
9192extension.
9193
9194In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
9195@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
9196@code{mode}.
9197@end deftypefn
9198
9199@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
9200A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
9201with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
9202(@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true.  This description must
9203apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
9204comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
9205
9206A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
9207comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
9208and 0 when the comparison is false.  Otherwise, the value indicates
9209which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
9210true.  This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
9211operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
9212@samp{s@var{cond}} pattern.  Either the low bit or the sign bit of
9213@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on.  Presently, only those bits are used by
9214the compiler.
9215
9216If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
9217generate code that depends only on the specified bits.  It can also
9218replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
9219the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
9220For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
9221@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
9222@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
9223expression
9224
9225@smallexample
9226(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
9227@end smallexample
9228
9229@noindent
9230can be converted to
9231
9232@smallexample
9233(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
9234@end smallexample
9235
9236@noindent
9237where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
9238tested into the sign bit.
9239
9240There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
9241for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
9242but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction.  If you
9243are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
9244perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
9245comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
9246
9247Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
9248from a comparison (or the condition codes).  Here are rules to guide the
9249choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
9250to be used:
9251
9252@itemize @bullet
9253@item
9254Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
9255@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}.  It is more efficient for the compiler to
9256``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
9257comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
9258combine the normalization with other operations.
9259
9260@item
9261For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
9262slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
9263other machines.
9264
9265@item
9266As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
9267exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
9268others.
9269
9270@item
9271Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
9272@end itemize
9273
9274Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
9275@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
9276instructions.  On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
9277those cases, e.g., one matching
9278
9279@smallexample
9280(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
9281@end smallexample
9282
9283Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
9284condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
9285@samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}.  On those
9286machines, define the appropriate patterns.  Use the names @code{incscc}
9287and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
9288@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values.  See
9289@file{rs6000.md} for some examples.  The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
9290find such instruction sequences on other machines.
9291
9292If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used.  You need
9293not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
9294instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
9295@end defmac
9296
9297@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
9298A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
9299returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
9300Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
9301floating-point values.  If there are no such operations, do not define
9302this macro.
9303@end defmac
9304
9305@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
9306A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
9307for vector comparisons.  The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
9308mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode.  Define
9309this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
9310return a vector result.  If there are no such operations, do not define
9311this macro.  Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
9312@code{constm1_rtx}.  This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
9313the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
9314given mode.
9315@end defmac
9316
9317@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
9318@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
9319A C expression that evaluates to true if the architecture defines a value
9320for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.  If so, @var{value}
9321should be set to this value.  If this macro is not defined, the value of
9322@code{clz} or @code{ctz} is assumed to be undefined.
9323
9324This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
9325relies on a particular value to get correct results.  Otherwise it
9326is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases.
9327
9328Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
9329and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
9330visible to the user.  Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
9331to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
9332breaking the API@.
9333@end defmac
9334
9335@defmac Pmode
9336An alias for the machine mode for pointers.  On most machines, define
9337this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
9338pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
9339On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
9340modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
9341
9342The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
9343@code{POINTER_SIZE}.  If it is not equal, you must define the macro
9344@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
9345to @code{Pmode}.
9346@end defmac
9347
9348@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
9349An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
9350being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions.  On most machines this
9351should be @code{QImode}.
9352@end defmac
9353
9354@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
9355In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
9356constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@.  On some
9357hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
9358where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
9359strict conformance to the C Standard.
9360
9361Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
9362convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
9363files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
9364@end defmac
9365
9366@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
9367Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
9368This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
9369C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
9370@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
9371@end defmac
9372
9373@findex #pragma
9374@findex pragma
9375@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
9376Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
9377If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
9378@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
9379for each pragma.  The macro may also do any
9380setup required for the pragmas.
9381
9382The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
9383other compilers for the same target.  In general, we discourage
9384definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
9385
9386If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
9387defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
9388
9389Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded.  All
9390@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
9391silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
9392@end defmac
9393
9394@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
9395@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
9396
9397Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
9398@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma.  The
9399@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
9400pragma of the form
9401
9402@smallexample
9403#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
9404@end smallexample
9405
9406@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
9407@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace.  The callback
9408routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
9409on to cpplib's functions if necessary.  You can lex tokens after the
9410@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}.  Tokens that are not read by the
9411callback will be silently ignored.  The end of the line is indicated by
9412a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.  Macro expansion occurs on the
9413arguments of pragmas registered with
9414@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
9415pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
9416
9417For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
9418routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
9419
9420Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
9421compilers.  It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
9422other language compilers for that matter.  Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
9423to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
9424building the C and C++ compilers.  This can be done by defining the
9425variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
9426target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file.  These variables should name
9427the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
9428code that uses @code{pragma_lex}.  Note it will also be necessary to add a
9429rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
9430how to build this object file.
9431@end deftypefun
9432
9433@findex #pragma
9434@findex pragma
9435@defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
9436Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
9437pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
9438[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
9439
9440The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
9441within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
9442@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A pack value of zero resets
9443the behavior to the default.
9444
9445A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
9446(e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
9447When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
9448of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
9449bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
9450and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
9451chunk of 32 bits.  However, if the size changes, a new field of that
9452size is allocated).
9453
9454If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
9455the latter will take precedence.  If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
9456used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
9457precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
9458may affect its placement.
9459
9460The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
9461@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined.  If enabled it allows the creation
9462of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
9463@end defmac
9464
9465@findex #pragma
9466@findex pragma
9467@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
9468Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
9469style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
9470pack(pop)}.  The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
9471alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
9472the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A
9473pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default.  Successive
9474invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
9475that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
9476value.
9477@end defmac
9478
9479@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
9480Define this macro, as well as
9481@code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
9482arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
9483@end defmac
9484
9485@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
9486If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
9487the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
9488This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
9489@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
9490@end defmac
9491
9492@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
9493Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
9494identifier names for the C family of languages.  0 means @samp{$} is
9495not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.  1 is the default;
9496there is no need to define this macro in that case.
9497@end defmac
9498
9499@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
9500Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
9501@samp{$} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in
9502G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers.  If this macro is defined,
9503@samp{.} is used instead.
9504@end defmac
9505
9506@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
9507Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
9508@samp{.} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in G++
9509have names that use @samp{.}.  If this macro is defined, these names
9510are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
9511@end defmac
9512
9513@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9514Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9515delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9516even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
9517@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
9518every @code{call_insn} has this behavior.  On machines where some @code{insn}
9519or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
9520you should define this macro.
9521
9522You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9523@end defmac
9524
9525@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9526Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9527delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9528even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
9529@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}.  On machines where
9530some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
9531are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
9532define this macro.  Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
9533instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
9534slot of @var{insn}.
9535
9536You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9537@end defmac
9538
9539@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
9540Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
9541global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
9542symbols in another translation unit without user intervention.  For
9543instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
9544from shared libraries (DLLs).
9545
9546You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
9547@end defmac
9548
9549@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
9550This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
9551any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
9552It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
9553clobber.  The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
9554corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
9555clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm.  You can use
9556@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
9557for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
9558@end deftypefn
9559
9560@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
9561Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
9562in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
9563separate math library.
9564
9565You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
9566@end defmac
9567
9568@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
9569Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
9570specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
9571
9572You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
9573is wrong.
9574@end defmac
9575
9576@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
9577Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
9578functions, access, mkdir and  file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
9579Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
9580to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
9581if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
9582for cross-profiling.
9583@end defmac
9584
9585@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
9586
9587A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
9588conditional execution instructions instead of a branch.  A value of
9589@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
95901 if it does use cc0.
9591@end defmac
9592
9593@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9594Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
9595conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
9596@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
9597contains information about the currently processed blocks.  @var{true_expr}
9598and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
9599then-block and the else-block, respectively.  Set either @var{true_expr} or
9600@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
9601@end defmac
9602
9603@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9604Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
9605if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
9606@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
9607being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
9608@end defmac
9609
9610@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
9611A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
9612be converted to conditional execution format.  @var{ce_info} points to
9613a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
9614about the currently processed blocks.
9615@end defmac
9616
9617@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
9618A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
9619converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
9620can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9621to by @var{ce_info}.
9622@end defmac
9623
9624@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
9625A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
9626converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
9627can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9628to by @var{ce_info}.
9629@end defmac
9630
9631@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
9632A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
9633structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9634@end defmac
9635
9636@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9637If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
9638added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure.  These should be initialized
9639by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9640@end defmac
9641
9642@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG ()
9643If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
9644instruction stream.  The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
9645just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
9646
9647The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target.  Some use
9648it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
9649laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
9650Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
9651
9652You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do.  The default
9653definition is null.
9654@end deftypefn
9655
9656@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
9657Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
9658that need to be defined.  It should be a function that performs the
9659necessary setup.
9660
9661Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
9662instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
9663they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
9664instructions or prefetch instructions).
9665
9666To create a built-in function, call the function
9667@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
9668which is defined by the language front end.  You can use any type nodes set
9669up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
9670only language front ends that use those two functions will call
9671@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
9672@end deftypefn
9673
9674@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
9675
9676Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
9677@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{exp} is the expression for the
9678function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
9679convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
9680@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
9681@var{exp}'s operands.  @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
9682ignored.  This function should return the result of the call to the
9683built-in function.
9684@end deftypefn
9685
9686@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{arglist})
9687
9688Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
9689was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  This is done
9690@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
9691implement a crude form of function overloading.  @var{fndecl} is the
9692declaration of the built-in function.  @var{arglist} is the list of
9693arguments passed to the built-in function.  The result is a
9694complete expression that implements the operation, usually
9695another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
9696@end deftypefn
9697
9698@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{arglist}, bool @var{ignore})
9699
9700Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
9701@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
9702built-in function.  @var{arglist} is the list of arguments passed to
9703the built-in function.  The result is another tree containing a
9704simplified expression for the call's result.  If @var{ignore} is true
9705the value will be ignored.
9706@end deftypefn
9707
9708@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char * TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (rtx @var{insn})
9709
9710Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
9711low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string why doloop could not be applied.
9712
9713Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
9714instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
9715the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
9716By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
9717loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
9718@end deftypefn
9719
9720@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
9721
9722Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
9723Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
9724@var{branch2} is possible.
9725
9726On some targets, branches may have a limited range.  Optimizing the
9727filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
9728may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
9729@end defmac
9730
9731@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (rtx @var{x}, @var{outer_code})
9732This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
9733Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
9734PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM.  @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
9735of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
9736@end deftypefn
9737
9738@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
9739
9740When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
9741register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
9742to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
9743it has been saved into can be used.  @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
9744is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
9745that had its initial value copied by using
9746@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
9747Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
9748to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
9749the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
9750@code{MEM}.
9751If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
9752it might decide to use another register anyways.
9753You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
9754that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
9755register in question will not be clobbered.
9756The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
9757allocation.
9758@end deftypefn
9759
9760@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
9761Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
9762files on your target machine.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will
9763use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
9764@end defmac
9765
9766@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
9767Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
9768automatically added to executable files on your target machine.  If you
9769do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
9770executable files.
9771@end defmac
9772
9773@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
9774If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
9775specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
9776Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
9777object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
9778lists.
9779@end defmac
9780
9781@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
9782Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
9783method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
9784must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
9785For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
9786the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
9787defined as this expression:
9788
9789@smallexample
9790build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
9791                              build_tree_list
9792                              (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
9793                               NULL))
9794@end smallexample
9795@end defmac
9796
9797@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
9798This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
9799instructions could be created.  On machines that require a register for
9800every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
9801reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
9802
9803@smallexample
9804static bool
9805cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
9806@{
9807  return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
9808@}
9809@end smallexample
9810@end deftypefn
9811
9812@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
9813This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
9814optimizations should be applied.  All registers in this class should be
9815usable interchangeably.  After reload, registers in this class will be
9816re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
9817to inter-block scheduling.
9818@end deftypefn
9819
9820@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
9821Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
9822registers
9823that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
9824returns true, they will be included.  The target code must than make sure
9825that all target registers in the class returned by
9826@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
9827saved.  @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
9828epilogues have already been generated.  Note, even if you only return
9829true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
9830to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
9831to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
9832@end deftypefn
9833
9834@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
9835If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
9836that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
9837that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
9838constant inline.  When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
9839more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
9840system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
9841The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
9842@end defmac
9843
9844@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
9845This target hook should register any extra include files for the
9846target.  The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
9847are present.  The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
9848The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
9849@end deftypefn
9850
9851@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
9852This target hook should register any extra include files for the
9853target before any standard headers.  The parameter @var{stdinc}
9854indicates if normal include files are present.  The parameter
9855@var{sysroot} is the system root directory.  The parameter
9856@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
9857@end deftypefn
9858
9859@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
9860This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
9861The parameter @var{path} is the include to register.  On Darwin
9862systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
9863that are different from @option{-I}.
9864@end deftypefn
9865
9866@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
9867This target hook returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
9868for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
9869@code{false} otherwise.  By default, the hook returns @code{true} for all
9870functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
9871@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
9872@end deftypefn
9873
9874@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
9875If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
9876target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
9877option.  The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
9878@end defmac
9879
9880@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
9881If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
9882@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
9883@end defmac
9884
9885@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
9886If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
9887guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
9888main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
9889important, an explicit memory barrier must be used.  This is true of
9890many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
9891``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
9892and ia64.  The default is @code{false}.
9893@end deftypefn
9894
9895@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (tree @var{typelist}, tree @var{funcdecl}, tree @var{val})
9896If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
9897illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
9898with prototype @var{typelist}.
9899@end deftypefn
9900
9901@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (tree @var{fromtype}, tree @var{totype})
9902If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
9903invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
9904if validity should be determined by the front end.
9905@end deftypefn
9906
9907@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, tree @var{type})
9908If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
9909invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
9910@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
9911if validity should be determined by the front end.
9912@end deftypefn
9913
9914@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9915If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
9916invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
9917and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
9918the front end.
9919@end deftypefn
9920
9921@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
9922This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
9923classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
9924SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
9925@end defmac
9926